]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
binutils, ld: dequote libctf error messages
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
b3adc24a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
b3adc24a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
b3adc24a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
129@ifset GENERIC
130* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
131@end ifset
132@ifclear GENERIC
133@ifset H8300
134* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
135@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
136@ifset Renesas
137* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 138@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
139@ifset ARM
140* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
141@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
142@ifset M68HC11
143* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
144@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
145@ifset HPPA
146* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
147@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
148@ifset M68K
149* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
150@end ifset
833794fc
MR
151@ifset MIPS
152* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
153@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
154@ifset POWERPC
155* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
156@end ifset
157@ifset POWERPC64
158* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
159@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
160@ifset S/390
161* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
162@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
163@ifset SPU
164* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
165@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
166@ifset TICOFF
167* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
168@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
169@ifset WIN32
170* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
171@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
172@ifset XTENSA
173* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
174@end ifset
252b5132
RH
175@end ifclear
176@ifclear SingleFormat
177* BFD:: BFD
178@end ifclear
179@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
180
181* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
182* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 183* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 184* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 185@end menu
84ec0e6d 186@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
187
188@node Overview
189@chapter Overview
190
191@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
192@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 193
0879a67a 194@ifset man
0285c67d 195@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 196ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
197@c man end
198
199@c man begin SEEALSO
200ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
201the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
202@file{ld}.
203@c man end
204@end ifset
205
206@c man begin DESCRIPTION
207
ff5dcc92 208@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 209their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 210compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 211
ff5dcc92 212@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
213a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
214to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
215
0285c67d
NC
216@ifset man
217@c For the man only
ece2d90e 218This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
219@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
220language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
221@end ifset
222
252b5132 223@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
224This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
225to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
226write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
227@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
228available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
229@end ifclear
230
231Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
232linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
233execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 234@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
235(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
236
0285c67d
NC
237@c man end
238
252b5132
RH
239@node Invocation
240@chapter Invocation
241
0285c67d
NC
242@c man begin DESCRIPTION
243
ff5dcc92 244The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
245and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
246you have many choices to control its behavior.
247
0285c67d
NC
248@c man end
249
252b5132
RH
250@ifset UsesEnvVars
251@menu
a05a5b64 252* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
253* Environment:: Environment Variables
254@end menu
255
256@node Options
a05a5b64 257@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
258@end ifset
259
260@cindex command line
261@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
262
263@c man begin OPTIONS
264
252b5132
RH
265The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
266practice few of them are used in any particular context.
267@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 268For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
269object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
270link a file @code{hello.o}:
271
272@smallexample
273ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
274@end smallexample
275
ff5dcc92 276This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
277result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
278the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
279directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
280
ff5dcc92 281Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
282point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
283as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
284which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
285files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
286different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
287occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
288option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
289noted in the descriptions below.
290
291@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
292Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
293together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
294options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
295an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
296
297Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
298specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
299and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
300are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
301message @samp{No input files}.
302
36f63dca 303If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
304assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
305augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
306linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
307permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
308or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
309@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
310script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
311extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
312to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
313the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
314
315For options whose names are a single letter,
316option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
317whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
318option that requires them.
319
320For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 321precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 322@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 323this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 324only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
325@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
326name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
327output.
328
329Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
330option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
331immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
332@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
333Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
334accepted.
252b5132 335
36f63dca 336Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 337(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
338prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
339compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
340
341@smallexample
2509a395 342 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
343@end smallexample
344
345This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
346silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
347may also arise when passing options that require values through a
348driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
349a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
350and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
351the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
352
353@smallexample
354 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
355@end smallexample
4e53152f 356
a05a5b64 357Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
358linker:
359
ff5dcc92 360@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 361@include at-file.texi
dff70155 362
2509a395
SL
363@kindex -a @var{keyword}
364@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
365This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
366argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
367@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
368@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
369to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
370
7ee314fa
AM
371@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
372@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
374@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
375specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
376will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
377finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 378it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 379This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 380interface.
7ee314fa 381
252b5132
RH
382@ifclear SingleFormat
383@cindex binary input format
384@kindex -b @var{format}
385@kindex --format=@var{format}
386@cindex input format
387@cindex input format
388@item -b @var{input-format}
389@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
390@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
391file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 392@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 393that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 394configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 395to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
396default input format the most usual format on each machine.
397@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
398supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
399formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
400@xref{BFD}.
401
402You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
403binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
404linking object files of different formats), by including
405@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 406particular format.
252b5132
RH
407
408The default format is taken from the environment variable
409@code{GNUTARGET}.
410@ifset UsesEnvVars
411@xref{Environment}.
412@end ifset
413You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
414@code{TARGET};
415@ifclear man
416see @ref{Format Commands}.
417@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
418@end ifclear
419
420@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
421@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@cindex compatibility, MRI
423@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
424@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 425For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 426files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
427@ifclear man
428@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
429@end ifclear
430@ifset man
431the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
432@end ifset
433Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 434the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
435scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
436If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
437specified by any @samp{-L} options.
438
439@cindex common allocation
440@kindex -d
441@kindex -dc
442@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 443@item -d
252b5132
RH
444@itemx -dc
445@itemx -dp
446These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
447compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
448even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
449script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
450@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
451
7ee314fa
AM
452@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
453@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
454@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
455@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
456Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
457@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
458specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
459will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
460option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 461The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 462
abf874aa
CL
463@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
464@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
466fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
467section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
468error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
469several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
470section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
471sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
472
473@smallexample
474 MEMORY @{
475 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
476 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
477 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 @}
479 SECTIONS @{
480 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
481 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
482 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 @}
484
485 with input sections:
486 .data.1: size 8
487 .data.2: size 0x10
488 .data.3: size 4
489
490 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
491 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
492@end smallexample
493
494This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
495the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
496
497@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
498@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499This option enables warnings when
500@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
501matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
502discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
503output region.
504
252b5132
RH
505@cindex entry point, from command line
506@kindex -e @var{entry}
507@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 508@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
509@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
510Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
511program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
512named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
513and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
514base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
515@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
516and other ways of specifying the entry point.
517
b58f81ae
DJ
518@kindex --exclude-libs
519@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
520Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 521exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
522@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
523automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
524port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
525explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
526option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
527be treated as hidden.
528
e1c37eb5
DK
529@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
530@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
531Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
532should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
533into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
534may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
535used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
536the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
537match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
538command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
539of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
540regardless of this option.
541
252b5132
RH
542@cindex dynamic symbol table
543@kindex -E
544@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 545@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
546@item -E
547@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
548@itemx --no-export-dynamic
549When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
550option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
551all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
552set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
553
554If you do not use either of these options (or use the
555@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
556dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
557referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
558
559If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
560back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
561dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
562linking the program itself.
563
55255dae 564You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 565be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 566See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 567
8b747e1a
DK
568Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
569support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
570the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
571
37a141bf
FS
572@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
573@cindex export dynamic symbol
574@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
575When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
576@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
577shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
578bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
579no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
580@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
581on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
582
583@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
584@cindex export dynamic symbol list
585@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
586Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
587The format of the file is the same as the version node without
588scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
589
36f63dca 590@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
591@cindex big-endian objects
592@cindex endianness
593@kindex -EB
594@item -EB
595Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
596
597@cindex little-endian objects
598@kindex -EL
599@item -EL
600Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 601@end ifclear
252b5132 602
2509a395
SL
603@kindex -f @var{name}
604@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
605@item -f @var{name}
606@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
607When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
608to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
609table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
610symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
611
612If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
613run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
614the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
615first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
616@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
617in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
618Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
619implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 620machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
621
622This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
623will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
624
2509a395
SL
625@kindex -F @var{name}
626@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 627@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 628@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
629When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
630the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
631of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
632on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
633
634If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
635run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
636dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
637filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
638found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
639used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
640@var{name}.
641
ff5dcc92 642Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 643toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
644object files.
645@ifclear SingleFormat
646The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 647@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 648@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
649environment variable.
650@end ifclear
651The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
652creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 653
3dbf70a2 654@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
655@kindex -fini=@var{name}
656@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
657When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
658executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
659address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
660the function to call.
661
252b5132
RH
662@kindex -g
663@item -g
664Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
665
2509a395
SL
666@kindex -G @var{value}
667@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 668@cindex object size
2509a395 669@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
670@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
671Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
672@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 673MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
674sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
675
676@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 677@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 678@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 679@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
680@itemx -soname=@var{name}
681When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
682the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
683which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
684linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
685field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
686
687@kindex -i
688@cindex incremental link
689@item -i
690Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
691
3dbf70a2 692@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
693@kindex -init=@var{name}
694@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
695When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
696executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
697of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
698function to call.
699
252b5132 700@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 701@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 702@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 703@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
704@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
705Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
706list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
707If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 708will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 709will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 710
ff5dcc92 711On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
712files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
713and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
714called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
715@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
716indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
717to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
718@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
719
720The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
721specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
722was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
723command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
724archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
725the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
726
ff5dcc92 727See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
728archives multiple times.
729
730You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
731
732@ifset GENERIC
733This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 734if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
735behaviour of the AIX linker.
736@end ifset
737
738@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 739@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 740@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 741@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 742@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
743Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
744for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
745option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
746in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
747on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 748@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
749order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
750how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
751option is specified.
252b5132 752
3aa2d05a
NC
753If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
754prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
755@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 756
252b5132
RH
757@ifset UsesEnvVars
758The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 759@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
760some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
761@end ifset
762
763The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
764@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
765at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
766
767@cindex emulation
768@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 769@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
770Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
771emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
772
773If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
774@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
775
776Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
777configured.
778
779@cindex link map
780@kindex -M
781@kindex --print-map
782@item -M
783@itemx --print-map
784Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
785information about the link, including the following:
786
787@itemize @bullet
788@item
3b83e13a 789Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
790@item
791How common symbols are allocated.
792@item
793All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
794which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
795@item
796The values assigned to symbols.
797
798Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
799involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
800have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
801linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
802of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
803the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
804linker script containing:
805
806@smallexample
807 foo = 1
808 foo = foo * 4
809 foo = foo + 8
810@end smallexample
811
812will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
813option is used:
814
815@smallexample
816 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
817 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
819@end smallexample
820
821See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
822scripts.
d2ef37eb 823
06ddcada
AM
824@item
825How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 826
06ddcada
AM
827When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
828.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
829These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
830
831@smallexample
832Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
833@end smallexample
834
06ddcada 835This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
836merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
837is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
838
839@smallexample
06ddcada 840Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
841@end smallexample
842
06ddcada 843This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
844when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
845is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
846@end itemize
847
035801ce
FS
848@cindex link map discarded
849@kindex --print-map-discarded
850@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
851@item --print-map-discarded
852@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
853Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
854in the link map. Enabled by default.
855
252b5132
RH
856@kindex -n
857@cindex read-only text
858@cindex NMAGIC
859@kindex --nmagic
860@item -n
861@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
862Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
863libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
864mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
865
866@kindex -N
867@kindex --omagic
868@cindex read/write from cmd line
869@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 870@item -N
252b5132
RH
871@itemx --omagic
872Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
873not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
874libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
875mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
876is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
877specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
878
879@kindex --no-omagic
880@cindex OMAGIC
881@item --no-omagic
882This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
883sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
884be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
885shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
886
887@kindex -o @var{output}
888@kindex --output=@var{output}
889@cindex naming the output file
890@item -o @var{output}
891@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 892Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
893option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
894script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
895
f37b21b4
RM
896@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
897@cindex dependency file
898@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
899Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
900suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
901that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
902output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
903Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
904Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
905to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
906linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
907@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
908installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
909distributed makefiles without careful editing.
910
252b5132
RH
911@kindex -O @var{level}
912@cindex generating optimized output
913@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 914If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 915the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
916should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
917option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
918the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
919no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
920of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 921
387dd777
DP
922@kindex -plugin @var{name}
923@item -plugin @var{name}
924Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
925the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
926automatically added by the complier, when using link time
927optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
928wish.
929
930Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
931from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
932@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
933those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 934copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 935based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 936just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 937
26278bb8
UD
938@kindex --push-state
939@cindex push state governing input file handling
940@item --push-state
941The @option{--push-state} allows to preserve the current state of the
942flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
943restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
944
945The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
946@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
947@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
948@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
949@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
950@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
951
952One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
953used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
954listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
955something as follows:
956
957@smallexample
958-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
959@end smallexample
960
961@kindex --pop-state
962@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 963@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
964Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
965flags governing input file handling.
966
a712da20
NC
967@kindex -q
968@kindex --emit-relocs
969@cindex retain relocations in final executable
970@item -q
971@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 972Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
973Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
974order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
975in larger executables.
976
dbab7a7b
NC
977This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
978
4f471f39
RS
979@kindex --force-dynamic
980@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
981@item --force-dynamic
982Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
983to VxWorks targets.
984
252b5132
RH
985@cindex partial link
986@cindex relocatable output
987@kindex -r
1049f94e 988@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 989@item -r
1049f94e 990@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 991Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 992turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
993linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
994magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
995@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 996@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
997If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
998linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
999constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1000
62bf86b4
HPN
1001When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1002partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1003relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1004example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1005with input files in other formats at all.
1006
252b5132
RH
1007This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1008
1009@kindex -R @var{file}
1010@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1011@cindex symbol-only input
1012@item -R @var{filename}
1013@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1014Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1015relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1016to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1017programs. You may use this option more than once.
1018
ff5dcc92 1019For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1020followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1021the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1022
1023@kindex -s
1024@kindex --strip-all
1025@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1026@item -s
252b5132
RH
1027@itemx --strip-all
1028Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1029
1030@kindex -S
1031@kindex --strip-debug
1032@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1033@item -S
252b5132
RH
1034@itemx --strip-debug
1035Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1036
a70f34c0
NC
1037@kindex --strip-discarded
1038@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1039@item --strip-discarded
1040@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1041Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1042Enabled by default.
1043
252b5132
RH
1044@kindex -t
1045@kindex --trace
1046@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1047@item -t
252b5132 1048@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1049Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1050@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1051@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1052and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1053a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1054
1055@kindex -T @var{script}
1056@kindex --script=@var{script}
1057@cindex script files
1058@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1059@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1060Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1061@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1062@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1063output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1064the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1065specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1066options accumulate.
252b5132 1067
14be8564
L
1068@kindex -dT @var{script}
1069@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1070@cindex script files
1071@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1072@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1073Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1074
1075This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1076processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1077command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1078@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1079behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1080command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1081the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1082@samp{gcc}).
1083
252b5132
RH
1084@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1085@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1086@cindex undefined symbol
1087@item -u @var{symbol}
1088@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1089Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1090symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1091modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1092different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1093option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1094
0a618243
AB
1095If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1096into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1097undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1098instead.
1099
1100@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1101@cindex symbols, require defined
1102@cindex defined symbol
1103@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1104Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1105is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1106is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1107and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1108@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1109can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1110
252b5132
RH
1111@kindex -Ur
1112@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1114For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1115@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1116turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1117@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1118It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1119with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1120be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1121@samp{-r} for the others.
1122
c005eb9e
AB
1123@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1124@cindex orphan sections
1125@cindex sections, orphan
1126@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1127Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1128specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1129
1130@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1131
1132@table @code
1133@item place
1134Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1135the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1136@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1137
1138@item discard
1139All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1140@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1141
1142@item warn
1143The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1144issue a warning.
1145
1146@item error
1147The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1148@end table
1149
1150The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1151
577a0623
AM
1152@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1153@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1155@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1156missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1157specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1158multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1159input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1160in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1161
252b5132
RH
1162@kindex -v
1163@kindex -V
1164@kindex --version
1165@cindex version
1166@item -v
1167@itemx --version
1168@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1169Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1170lists the supported emulations.
1171
1172@kindex -x
1173@kindex --discard-all
1174@cindex deleting local symbols
1175@item -x
1176@itemx --discard-all
1177Delete all local symbols.
1178
1179@kindex -X
1180@kindex --discard-locals
1181@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1182@item -X
252b5132 1183@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1184Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1185system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1186or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1187
1188@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1189@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1190@cindex symbol tracing
1191@item -y @var{symbol}
1192@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1193Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1194option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1195to prepend an underscore.
1196
1197This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1198don't know where the reference is coming from.
1199
1200@kindex -Y @var{path}
1201@item -Y @var{path}
1202Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1203for Solaris compatibility.
1204
1205@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1206@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1207The recognized keywords are:
1208@table @samp
1209
e6e2dfbd
AM
1210@item bndplt
1211Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1212
1213@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1214@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1215@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1216@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1217Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1218to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1219@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1220@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1221@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1222@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1223Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1224
233a0083
L
1225@item cet-report=none
1226@itemx cet-report=warning
1227@itemx cet-report=error
1228Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1229GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1230section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1231linker not report missing properties in input files.
1232@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1233missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1234the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1235Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1236GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1237turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1238Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1239
cd6d6c15 1240@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1241@itemx nocombreloc
1242Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1243dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1244
b8871f35 1245@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1246@itemx nocommon
1247Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1248link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1249
1250@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1251Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1252layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1253using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1254
cd6d6c15 1255@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1256Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1257is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1258This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1259
e6e2dfbd
AM
1260@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1261@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1262Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1263if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1264by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1265@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1266may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1267selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1268these options.
1269
6aa29e7b
JJ
1270@item execstack
1271Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1272
b039ef04
L
1273@item global
1274This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1275the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1276of subsequently loaded libraries.
1277
93ab9c0d
NC
1278@item globalaudit
1279This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1280This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1281setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1282tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1283the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1284all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1285
e6e2dfbd
AM
1286@item ibtplt
1287Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1288Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1289
8df93cb5 1290@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1291Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1292to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1293Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1294
cd6d6c15
NC
1295@item initfirst
1296This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1297It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1298before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1299the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1300the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1301objects.
1302
1303@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1304Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1305so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1306libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1307
5fa222e4
AM
1308@item lazy
1309When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1310dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1311the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1312Lazy binding is the default.
1313
cd6d6c15 1314@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1315Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1316
e6e2dfbd
AM
1317@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1318Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1319
e6e2dfbd
AM
1320@item muldefs
1321Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1322
cd6d6c15 1323@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1324Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1325defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1326
1327@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1328Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1329should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1330
1331@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1332Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1333
1334@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1335Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1336
1337@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1338Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1339
6aa29e7b
JJ
1340@item noexecstack
1341Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1342
e6e2dfbd
AM
1343@item noextern-protected-data
1344Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1345library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1346used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1347generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1348module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1349i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1350
e6e2dfbd
AM
1351@item noreloc-overflow
1352Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1353relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1354overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1355
cd6d6c15
NC
1356@item now
1357When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1358dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1359when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1360function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1361called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1362
1363@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1364Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1365
6aa29e7b 1366@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1367@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1368Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1369specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1370relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1371than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1372Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1373
47acac12
L
1374@item separate-code
1375@itemx noseparate-code
1376Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1377specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1378be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1379code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1380
e6e2dfbd
AM
1381@item shstk
1382Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1383to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1384Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1385
04c3a755 1386@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1388Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1389@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1390
cae64165
RM
1391@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1392@cindex visibility
1393@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1394Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1395@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1396Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1397@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1398start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1399compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1400recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1401programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1402between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1403
e6e2dfbd
AM
1404@item text
1405@itemx notext
1406@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1407Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1408or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1409report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1410
97a232d7
NC
1411@item undefs
1412Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1413either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1414This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1415
cd6d6c15
NC
1416@end table
1417
ece2d90e 1418Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1419
1420@kindex -(
1421@cindex groups of archives
1422@item -( @var{archives} -)
1423@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1424The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1425either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1426
1427The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1428references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1429the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1430archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1431object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1432would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1433they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1434resolved.
1435
1436Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1437it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1438more archives.
1439
69da35b5
NC
1440@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1441@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1442@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1443@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1444Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1445recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1446and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1447the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1448behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1449so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1450restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1451
4a43e768
AM
1452@kindex --as-needed
1453@kindex --no-as-needed
1454@item --as-needed
1455@itemx --no-as-needed
1456This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1457on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1458the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1459on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1460needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1461emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1462non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1463the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1464non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1465Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1466the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1467needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1468from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1469
e56f61be
L
1470@kindex --add-needed
1471@kindex --no-add-needed
1472@item --add-needed
1473@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1474These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1475their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1476options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1477and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1478
252b5132
RH
1479@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1480@item -assert @var{keyword}
1481This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1482
1483@kindex -Bdynamic
1484@kindex -dy
1485@kindex -call_shared
1486@item -Bdynamic
1487@itemx -dy
1488@itemx -call_shared
1489Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1490for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1491default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1492for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1493multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1494@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1495
a1ab1d2a
UD
1496@kindex -Bgroup
1497@item -Bgroup
1498Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1499section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1500object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1501@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1502only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1503
252b5132
RH
1504@kindex -Bstatic
1505@kindex -dn
1506@kindex -non_shared
1507@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1508@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1509@itemx -dn
1510@itemx -non_shared
1511@itemx -static
1512Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1513platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1514variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1515may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1516library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1517option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1518option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1519shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1520references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1521libraries.
252b5132
RH
1522
1523@kindex -Bsymbolic
1524@item -Bsymbolic
1525When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1526definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1527for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1528within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1529platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1530
40b36307
L
1531@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1532@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1533When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1534symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1535This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1536libraries.
40b36307 1537
55255dae
L
1538@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1539@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1540Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1541typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1542global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1543within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1544to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1545in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1546which support shared libraries.
1547
1548The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1549scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1550
40b36307
L
1551@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1552@item --dynamic-list-data
1553Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1554
1555@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1556@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1557Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1558is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1559
0b8a70d9
L
1560@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1561@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1562Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1563
252b5132
RH
1564@kindex --check-sections
1565@kindex --no-check-sections
1566@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1567@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1568Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1569been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1570perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1571suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1572allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1573restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1574Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1575force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1576option.
252b5132 1577
ddbb8a31
NC
1578@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1579@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1580@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1581@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1582This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1583by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1584command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1585output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1586input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1587specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1588follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1589behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1590
1591This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1592libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1593mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1594their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1595required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1596the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1597dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1598symbols.
1599
252b5132
RH
1600@cindex cross reference table
1601@kindex --cref
1602@item --cref
1603Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1604generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1605Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1606
1607The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1608easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1609sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1610symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1611definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1612where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1613symbol are listed.
252b5132 1614
5dba6f05
NA
1615@cindex ctf variables
1616@kindex --ctf-variables
1617@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1618@item --ctf-variables
1619@item --no-ctf-variables
1620The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1621types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1622table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1623conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1624usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1625@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1626The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1627
1628@cindex ctf type sharing
1629@kindex --ctf-share-types
1630@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1631Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1632
1633@table @samp
1634@item share-unconflicted
1635Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1636where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1637translation unit. This is the default.
1638
1639@item share-duplicated
1640Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1641dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1642dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1643always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1644larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1645large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1646consumer at runtime.
1647@end table
1648
4818e05f
AM
1649@cindex common allocation
1650@kindex --no-define-common
1651@item --no-define-common
1652This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1653The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1654@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1655
1656The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1657the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1658of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1659forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1660Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1661from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1662This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1663and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1664duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1665paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1666
7bdf4127
AB
1667@cindex group allocation in linker script
1668@cindex section groups
1669@cindex COMDAT
1670@kindex --force-group-allocation
1671@item --force-group-allocation
1672This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1673normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1674default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1675change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1676command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1677effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1678
252b5132 1679@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1680@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1681@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1682Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1683address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1684times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1685limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1686context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1687symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1688constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1689using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1690@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1691equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132
RH
1692
1693@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1694@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1695@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1696@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1697@itemx --no-demangle
1698These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1699and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1700present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1701underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1702mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1703different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1704to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1705demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1706is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1707
1708@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1709@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1710@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1711@item -I@var{file}
1712@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1713Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1714generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1715linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1716doing.
1717
9b8b325a
RF
1718@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1719@item --no-dynamic-linker
1720When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1721linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1722executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1723entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1724
a70f34c0
NC
1725@kindex --embedded-relocs
1726@item --embedded-relocs
1727This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1728that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1729is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1730targets.
1731
3f0a5f17
ME
1732@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1733@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1734Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1735in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1736
7ce691ae 1737@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1738@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1739@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1740@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1741Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1742with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1743
252b5132
RH
1744@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1745@item --force-exe-suffix
1746Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1747
1748If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1749@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1750the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1751option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1752Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1753it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1754
1755@kindex --gc-sections
1756@kindex --no-gc-sections
1757@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1758@item --gc-sections
1759@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1760Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1761targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1762performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1763@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1764collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1765implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1766
d5465ba2
AM
1767@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1768examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1769symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1770command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1771referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1772libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1773referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1774the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1775relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1776@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1777
ac69cbc6 1778This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1779@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1780specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1781@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1782command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1783
c17d87de
NC
1784@kindex --print-gc-sections
1785@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1786@cindex garbage collection
1787@item --print-gc-sections
1788@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1789List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1790printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1791collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1792default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1793be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1794line.
1795
22185505 1796@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1797@cindex garbage collection
1798@item --gc-keep-exported
1799When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1800collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1801default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1802executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1803collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1804Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1805it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1806ELF format targets.
1807
30824704
RM
1808@kindex --print-output-format
1809@cindex output format
1810@item --print-output-format
1811Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1812other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1813in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1814
3604cb1f
TG
1815@kindex --print-memory-usage
1816@cindex memory usage
1817@item --print-memory-usage
1818Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1819the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1820quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1821headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1822parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1823
1824@smallexample
1825Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1826 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1827 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1828@end smallexample
1829
252b5132
RH
1830@cindex help
1831@cindex usage
1832@kindex --help
1833@item --help
1834Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1835
ea20a7da
CC
1836@kindex --target-help
1837@item --target-help
a094d01f 1838Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1839
2509a395
SL
1840@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1841@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1842Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
72a3b182
NC
1843@option{-M} option, above. Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile}
1844causes the linker map to be written into a file inside the directory.
1845The name of the file is based upon the @var{output} filename with
1846@code{.map} appended.
252b5132
RH
1847
1848@cindex memory usage
1849@kindex --no-keep-memory
1850@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1851@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1852symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1853instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1854necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1855while linking a large executable.
1856
1857@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1858@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1859@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1860@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1861@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1862Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1863is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1864The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1865behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1866libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1867
97a232d7
NC
1868The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1869
aa713662
L
1870@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1871@kindex -z muldefs
1872@item --allow-multiple-definition
1873@itemx -z muldefs
1874Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1875report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1876first definition will be used.
1877
b79e8c78 1878@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1879@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1880@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1881@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1882Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1883This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1884determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1885shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1886how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1887
903249d7
NC
1888The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1889referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1890an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1891a shared library.
1892
1893The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
1894libraries specified at link time are that:
1895
1896@itemize @bullet
1897@item
1898A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
1899that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
1900resolvable at load time.
1901@item
1902There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
1903symbols in shared libraries are normal.
1904
1905The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
1906select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
1907architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
1908appropriate memset function.
1909@end itemize
b79e8c78 1910
31941635
L
1911@kindex --no-undefined-version
1912@item --no-undefined-version
1913Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
1914it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
1915will be issued instead.
1916
3e3b46e5
PB
1917@kindex --default-symver
1918@item --default-symver
1919Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
1920exported symbols.
1921
1922@kindex --default-imported-symver
1923@item --default-imported-symver
1924Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
1925imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 1926
252b5132
RH
1927@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
1928@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 1929Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
1930files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
1931been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 1932This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
1933errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
1934have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
1935inappropriate.
1936
fe7929ce
AM
1937@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
1938@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
1939Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
1940library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
1941
252b5132
RH
1942@kindex --no-whole-archive
1943@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 1944Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
1945archive files.
1946
1947@cindex output file after errors
1948@kindex --noinhibit-exec
1949@item --noinhibit-exec
1950Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
1951Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
1952errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
1953when it issues any error whatsoever.
1954
0a9c1c8e
CD
1955@kindex -nostdlib
1956@item -nostdlib
1957Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
1958command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
1959(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
1960
252b5132 1961@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
1962@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
1963@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
1964@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
1965file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 1966@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
1967object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
1968object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
1969should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
1970usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
1971name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
1972list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
1973command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
1974this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
1975@end ifclear
1976
76359541
TP
1977@kindex --out-implib
1978@item --out-implib @var{file}
1979Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
1980the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
1981library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
1982may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
1983behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
1984step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
1985the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
1986
36af4a4e
JJ
1987@kindex -pie
1988@kindex --pic-executable
1989@item -pie
1990@itemx --pic-executable
1991@cindex position independent executables
1992Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
1993ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
1994libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 1995address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
1996normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
1997defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
1998
252b5132
RH
1999@kindex -qmagic
2000@item -qmagic
2001This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2002
2003@kindex -Qy
2004@item -Qy
2005This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2006
2007@kindex --relax
2008@cindex synthesizing linker
2009@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2010@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2011@item --relax
28d5f677 2012@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2013An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2014@ifset GENERIC
2015This option is only supported on a few targets.
2016@end ifset
2017@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2018@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2019@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2020@ifset XTENSA
2021@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2022@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2023@ifset M68HC11
2024@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2025@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2026@ifset NIOSII
2027@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2028@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2029@ifset POWERPC
2030@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2031@end ifset
252b5132 2032
ccd9fae5 2033On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2034global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2035addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2036synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2037instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2038
2039On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2040debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2041@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2042This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2043family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2044@end ifset
2045
ccd9fae5
NC
2046On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2047@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2048
ccd9fae5
NC
2049On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2050and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2051
252b5132
RH
2052@cindex retaining specified symbols
2053@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2054@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2055@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2056@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2057Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2058discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2059symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2060@ifset GENERIC
2061(such as VxWorks)
2062@end ifset
2063where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2064run-time memory.
2065
2066@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2067or symbols needed for relocations.
2068
2069You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2070line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2071
2072@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2073@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2074@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2075@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2076Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2077linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2078arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2079them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2080
2081The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2082are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2083description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2084in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2085have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2086
2087If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2088contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2089is defined.
252b5132 2090
ff5dcc92 2091The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2092SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2093@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2094runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2095options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2096gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2097file systems.
252b5132 2098
ff5dcc92 2099For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2100followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2101the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2102@end ifset
2103
2104@ifset GENERIC
2105@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2106@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2107@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2108When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2109happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2110of the input files.
2111
2112When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2113non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2114shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2115explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2116specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2117@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2118either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2119appearing multiple times.
2120
e680a6b6
NC
2121The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2122directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2123containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2124and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
212564-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2126
2127The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2128@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2129supported.
2130
28c309a2
NC
2131This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2132that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2133is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2134runtime linker would do.
2135
252b5132 2136The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2137libraries:
d8e4137b 2138
252b5132
RH
2139@enumerate
2140@item
ff5dcc92 2141Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2142@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2143Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2144between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2145specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2146used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2147at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2148by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2149the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2150@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2151On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2152@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2153environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2154@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2155On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2156directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2157@item
a1b8d843 2158For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2159variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2160@item
ec4eb78a
L
2161For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2162@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2163libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2164@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2165@item
252b5132
RH
2166The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2167@item
d8e4137b
NC
2168For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2169exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2170to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2171defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2172configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2173@item
2174For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2175the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2176header file.
2177@item
2178Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2179linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2180@end enumerate
2181
2182If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2183warning and continue with the link.
2184@end ifset
2185
2186@kindex -shared
2187@kindex -Bshareable
2188@item -shared
2189@itemx -Bshareable
2190@cindex shared libraries
2191Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2192and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2193shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2194undefined symbols in the link.
2195
252b5132 2196@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2197@item --sort-common
2198@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2199@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2200This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2201ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2202sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2203eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2204between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2205specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2206
2509a395
SL
2207@kindex --sort-section=name
2208@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2209This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2210patterns in the linker script.
2211
2509a395
SL
2212@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2213@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2214This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2215patterns in the linker script.
2216
a70f34c0
NC
2217@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2218@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2219This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2220.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2221post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2222
252b5132 2223@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2224@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2225Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2226each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2227size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2228
2229@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2230@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2231Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2232output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2233This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2234certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2235cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2236that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2237support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2238input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2239more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2240many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2241
2242@kindex --stats
2243@item --stats
2244Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2245as execution time and memory usage.
2246
2509a395 2247@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2248@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2249Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2250configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2251that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2252
a70f34c0
NC
2253@kindex --task-link
2254@item --task-link
2255This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2256file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2257
252b5132
RH
2258@kindex --traditional-format
2259@cindex traditional format
2260@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2261For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2262the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2263use the traditional format instead.
2264
2265@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2266For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2267symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2268full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2269@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2270trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2271combine duplicate entries.
2272
2509a395
SL
2273@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2274@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2275Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2276address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2277times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2278line.
2279@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2280for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2281@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2282should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2283sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2284
2509a395
SL
2285@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2286@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2287@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2288@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2289@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2290@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2291@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2292Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2293@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2294
2509a395
SL
2295@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2296@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2297@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2298When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2299byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2300
9d5777a3
RM
2301@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2302@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2303@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2304When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2305the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2306text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2307
0d705e9f
AM
2308@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2309@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2310@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2311When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2312model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2313
560e09e9
NC
2314@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2315@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2316Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2317values for @samp{method}:
2318
2319@table @samp
2320@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2321Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2322
2323@item report-all
da8bce14 2324Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2325
2326@item ignore-in-object-files
2327Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2328ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2329
2330@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2331Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2332ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2333when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2334libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2335command line.
2336@end table
2337
2338The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2339by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2340
2341Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2342unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2343can change this to a warning.
2344
1715a13c
L
2345@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2346@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2347@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2348@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2349Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2350supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2351the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2352argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2353
2354@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2355@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2356@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2357Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2358used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2359about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2360is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2361see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2362use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2363symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2364@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2365
7ce691ae 2366@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2367@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2368@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2369@item --warn-common
2370Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2371a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2372but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2373you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2374Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2375warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2376
2377There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2378
2379@table @samp
2380@item int i = 1;
2381A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2382file.
2383
2384@item extern int i;
2385An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2386There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2387variable somewhere.
2388
2389@item int i;
2390A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2391variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2392The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2393single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2394size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2395a definition of the same variable.
2396@end table
2397
2398The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2399Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2400just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2401encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2402a common symbol.
2403
2404@enumerate
2405@item
2406Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2407definition for the symbol.
2408@smallexample
2409@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2410 overridden by definition
2411@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2412@end smallexample
2413
2414@item
2415Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2416the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2417except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2418@smallexample
2419@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2420 overriding common
2421@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2422@end smallexample
2423
2424@item
2425Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2426@smallexample
2427@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2428 of `@var{symbol}'
2429@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2430@end smallexample
2431
2432@item
2433Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2434@smallexample
2435@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2436 overridden by larger common
2437@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2438@end smallexample
2439
2440@item
2441Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2442the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2443encountered in a different order.
2444@smallexample
2445@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2446 overriding smaller common
2447@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2448@end smallexample
2449@end enumerate
2450
2451@kindex --warn-constructors
2452@item --warn-constructors
2453Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2454object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2455detect the use of global constructors.
2456
2457@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2458@item --warn-multiple-gp
2459Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2460This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2461Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2462section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2463of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2464base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2465base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2466bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2467large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2468values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2469option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2470
2471@kindex --warn-once
2472@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2473@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2474@item --warn-once
2475Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2476which refers to it.
2477
2478@kindex --warn-section-align
2479@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2480@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2481@item --warn-section-align
2482Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2483alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2484The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2485is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2486the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2487
a6dbf402
L
2488@kindex --warn-textrel
2489@item --warn-textrel
2490Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2491or shared object.
8fdd7217 2492
a0c402a5
L
2493@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2494@item --warn-alternate-em
2495Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2496
560e09e9
NC
2497@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2498@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2499If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2500@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2501This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2502
2503@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2504@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2505This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2506it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2507
252b5132
RH
2508@kindex --whole-archive
2509@cindex including an entire archive
2510@item --whole-archive
2511For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2512@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2513in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2514files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2515library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2516library. This option may be used more than once.
2517
7ec229ce 2518Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2519about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2520Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2521list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2522your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2523
2509a395
SL
2524@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2525@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2526Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2527@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2528undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2529@var{symbol}.
2530
2531This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2532wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2533wishes to call the system function, it should call
2534@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2535
2536Here is a trivial example:
2537
2538@smallexample
2539void *
cc2f008e 2540__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2541@{
cc2f008e 2542 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2543 return __real_malloc (c);
2544@}
2545@end smallexample
2546
ff5dcc92 2547If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2548all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2549instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2550call the real @code{malloc} function.
2551
2552You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2553links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2554you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2555file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2556call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2557
4ea904ed
SH
2558Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2559internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2560@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2561@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2562
2563@smallexample
2564int
2565f (void)
2566@{
2567 return 123;
2568@}
2569
2570int
2571g (void)
2572@{
2573 return f();
2574@}
2575@end smallexample
2576
6aa29e7b 2577@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2578@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2579@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2580@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2581Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2582(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2583section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2584
e41b3a13
JJ
2585@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2586@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2587Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2588generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2589if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2590
6c1439be
L
2591@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2592@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2593@item --enable-new-dtags
2594@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2595This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2596systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2597@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2598and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2599If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2600created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2601those options are only available for ELF systems.
2602
2d643429 2603@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2604@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2605Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2606close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2607time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2608increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2609value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2610
fdc90cb4
JJ
2611@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2612@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2613Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2614@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2615new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2616the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2617hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2618but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2619
0ce398f1
L
2620@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2621@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2622@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2623@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2624@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2625@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2626@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2627@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2628On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2629compressed using zlib.
2630
2631@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2632sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2633DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2634instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2635also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2636sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2637
2638The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2639@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2640
2641Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2642sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2643for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2644uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2645
2646The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2647involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2648default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2649@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2650
35835446
JR
2651@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2652@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2653This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2654linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2655for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2656about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2657
4f9c04f7 2658Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 26591021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2660run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2661has been used.
2662
2663The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2664enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2665
c0065db7
RM
2666@kindex --build-id
2667@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2668@item --build-id
2669@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2670Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2671or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2672unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2673@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2674@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2675@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2676the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2677string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2678@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2679is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2680
2681The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2682that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2683unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2684to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2685file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2686string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2687
2688Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2689@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2690@end table
2691
0285c67d
NC
2692@c man end
2693
36f63dca 2694@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2695
0285c67d
NC
2696@c man begin OPTIONS
2697
ff5dcc92 2698The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2699the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2700normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2701use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2702@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2703like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2704symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2705object file).
2706
2707In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2708support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2709PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2710values by either a space or an equals sign.
2711
ff5dcc92 2712@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2713
2714@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2715@item --add-stdcall-alias
2716If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2717as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2718[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2719
2720@kindex --base-file
2721@item --base-file @var{file}
2722Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2723addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2724@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2725[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2726
2727@kindex --dll
2728@item --dll
2729Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2730@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2731file.
bb10df36 2732[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2733
88183869
DK
2734@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2735@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2736@item --enable-long-section-names
2737@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2738The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2739the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2740for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2741fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2742to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2743allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2744disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2745generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2746as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2747with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2748GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2749information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2750option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2751section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2752when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2753image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2754[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2755
252b5132
RH
2756@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2757@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2758@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2759@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2760If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2761do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2762only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2763resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2764undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2765@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2766to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2767warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2768import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2769to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2770feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2771@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2772mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2773[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2774
522f09cd
KT
2775@kindex --leading-underscore
2776@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2777@item --leading-underscore
2778@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2779For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2780in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2781disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2782
252b5132
RH
2783@cindex DLLs, creating
2784@kindex --export-all-symbols
2785@item --export-all-symbols
2786If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2787be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2788otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2789explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2790attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2791option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2792@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2793@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2794exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2795re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2796such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2797@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2798@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2799Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2800not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2801extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2802(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2803These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2804@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2805@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2806@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2807@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2808[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2809
2810@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2811@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2812Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2813exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2814[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2815
2927aaca
NC
2816@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2817@item --exclude-all-symbols
2818Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2819[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2820
252b5132
RH
2821@kindex --file-alignment
2822@item --file-alignment
2823Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2824file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2825512.
bb10df36 2826[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2827
2828@cindex heap size
2829@kindex --heap
2830@item --heap @var{reserve}
2831@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2832Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2833to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2834committed.
bb10df36 2835[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2836
2837@cindex image base
2838@kindex --image-base
2839@item --image-base @var{value}
2840Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2841the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2842is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2843your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2844other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2845for dlls.
bb10df36 2846[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2847
2848@kindex --kill-at
2849@item --kill-at
2850If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2851symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2852[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2853
26d2d8a2
BF
2854@kindex --large-address-aware
2855@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2856If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2857header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2858greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2859or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2860section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2861[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2862
f69a2f97
NC
2863@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2864@item --disable-large-address-aware
2865Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2866This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2867driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2868addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2869[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2870
252b5132
RH
2871@kindex --major-image-version
2872@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2873Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2874[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2875
2876@kindex --major-os-version
2877@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2878Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2879[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2880
2881@kindex --major-subsystem-version
2882@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2883Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 2884[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2885
2886@kindex --minor-image-version
2887@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2888Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2889[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2890
2891@kindex --minor-os-version
2892@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2893Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2894[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2895
2896@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
2897@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2898Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 2899[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2900
2901@cindex DEF files, creating
2902@cindex DLLs, creating
2903@kindex --output-def
2904@item --output-def @var{file}
2905The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
2906file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
2907(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
2908library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
2909automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 2910[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2911
b044cda1 2912@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
2913@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
2914@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
2915@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
2916Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
2917@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
2918By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
2919for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
2920execution are avoided.
bb10df36 2921[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2922
2923@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
2924@item --disable-auto-image-base
2925Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
2926user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
2927default.
bb10df36 2928[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2929
2930@cindex DLLs, linking to
2931@kindex --dll-search-prefix
2932@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 2933When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 2934search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 2935@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
2936between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
2937uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 2938@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 2939[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
2940
2941@kindex --enable-auto-import
2942@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 2943Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
2944DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
2945mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
2946[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2947
2948The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
2949feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
2950
2951Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
2952of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
2953PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 2954
e2a83dd0
NC
2955Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
2956data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
2957placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
2958around a problem with consts that is described here:
2959http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
2960
4d8907ac
DS
2961Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
2962see this message:
0d888aac 2963
ece2d90e 2964"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
2965documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
2966
ece2d90e
NC
2967This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
2968ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
2969allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
2970fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
2971constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
2972multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
2973this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
2974of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
2975the warning, and exit.
2976
2977There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
2978data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 2979
2fa9fc65
NC
2980One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
2981of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 2982this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 2983
c0065db7
RM
2984A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
2985that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
2986there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
2987a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
2988
2989@example
2990extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 2991extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
2992 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
2993@end example
2994
2995or
2996
2997@example
2998extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 2999extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3000 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3001@end example
3002
c0065db7 3003For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3004is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3005
3006@example
3007extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3008extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3009 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3010@end example
3011
c406afaf
NC
3012or
3013
3014@example
3015extern long long extern_ll;
3016extern_ll -->
3017 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3018@end example
3019
2fa9fc65 3020A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3021'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3022@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3023requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3024building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3025merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3026between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3027constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3028
3029Original:
3030@example
3031--foo.h
3032extern int arr[];
3033--foo.c
3034#include "foo.h"
3035void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3036 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3037@}
3038@end example
3039
3040Solution 1:
3041@example
3042--foo.h
3043extern int arr[];
3044--foo.c
3045#include "foo.h"
3046void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3047 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3048 volatile int *parr = arr;
3049 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3050@}
3051@end example
3052
3053Solution 2:
3054@example
3055--foo.h
3056/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3057#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3058 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3059#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3060#else
3061#define FOO_IMPORT
3062#endif
3063extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3064--foo.c
3065#include "foo.h"
3066void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3067 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3068@}
3069@end example
3070
c0065db7 3071A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3072library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3073for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3074functions).
b044cda1
CW
3075
3076@kindex --disable-auto-import
3077@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3078Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3079@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3080[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3081
2fa9fc65
NC
3082@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3083@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3084If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3085that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3086a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3087environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3088[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3089
3090@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3091@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3092Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3093[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3094
b044cda1
CW
3095@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3096@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3097Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3098[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3099
252b5132
RH
3100@kindex --section-alignment
3101@item --section-alignment
3102Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3103addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3105
3106@cindex stack size
3107@kindex --stack
3108@item --stack @var{reserve}
3109@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3110Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3111to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3112committed.
bb10df36 3113[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3114
3115@kindex --subsystem
3116@item --subsystem @var{which}
3117@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3118@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3119Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3120legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3121@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3122the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3123@var{which}.
bb10df36 3124[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3125
2f563b51
DK
3126The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3127of the PE file header:
3128[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3129
2d5c3743
NC
3130@kindex --high-entropy-va
3131@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3132@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3133Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3134(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3135
dc9bd8c9
HD
3136This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3137@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3138
2f563b51
DK
3139@kindex --dynamicbase
3140@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3141@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3142The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3143randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3144Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3145can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3146This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3147
3148@kindex --forceinteg
3149@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3150@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3151Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3152default.
2f563b51
DK
3153
3154@kindex --nxcompat
3155@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3156@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3157The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3158This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3159targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3160
3161@kindex --no-isolation
3162@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3163@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3164Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3165This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3166
3167@kindex --no-seh
3168@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3169@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3170The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3171this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3172
3173@kindex --no-bind
3174@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3175@itemx --disable-no-bind
3176Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3177
3178@kindex --wdmdriver
3179@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3180@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3181The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3182by default.
9d5777a3 3183
2f563b51
DK
3184@kindex --tsaware
3185@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3186@itemx --disable-tsaware
3187The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3188default.
2f563b51 3189
0cb112f7
CF
3190@kindex --insert-timestamp
3191@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3192@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3193Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3194as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3195other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3196will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3197same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3198can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3199that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3200identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3201
3202@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3203@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3204@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3205Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3206is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3207This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3208@end table
3209
0285c67d
NC
3210@c man end
3211
ac145307
BS
3212@ifset C6X
3213@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3214
3215@c man begin OPTIONS
3216
3217The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3218libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3219all executables use an index of 0.
3220
3221@table @gcctabopt
3222
3223@kindex --dsbt-size
3224@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3225This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3226or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3227entries.
3228
3229@kindex --dsbt-index
3230@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3231This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3232to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3233executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3234@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3235
fbd9ad90
PB
3236@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3237The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3238exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3239
ac145307
BS
3240@end table
3241
3242@c man end
3243@end ifset
3244
b8891f8d
AJ
3245@ifset CSKY
3246@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3247
3248@c man begin OPTIONS
3249
3250@table @gcctabopt
3251
3252@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3253@item --branch-stub
3254This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3255sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3256usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3257can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3258the compiler or assembler.
3259
3260@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3261@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3262This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3263It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3264be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3265stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3266sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3267@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3268linker should choose suitable defaults.
3269
3270@end table
3271
3272@c man end
3273@end ifset
3274
93fd0973
SC
3275@ifset M68HC11
3276@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3277
3278@c man begin OPTIONS
3279
3280The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3281memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3282
3283@table @gcctabopt
3284
3285@kindex --no-trampoline
3286@item --no-trampoline
3287This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3288is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3289instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3290
3291@kindex --bank-window
3292@item --bank-window @var{name}
3293This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3294the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3295The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3296paging and addresses within the memory window.
3297
3298@end table
3299
3300@c man end
3301@end ifset
3302
7fb9f789
NC
3303@ifset M68K
3304@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3305
3306@c man begin OPTIONS
3307
3308The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3309when linking for 68K targets.
3310
3311@table @gcctabopt
3312
3313@kindex --got
3314@item --got=@var{type}
3315This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3316@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3317@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3318Info entry for @file{ld}.
3319
3320@end table
3321
3322@c man end
3323@end ifset
3324
833794fc
MR
3325@ifset MIPS
3326@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3327
3328@c man begin OPTIONS
3329
3330The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3331generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3332linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3333
3334@table @gcctabopt
3335
3336@kindex --insn32
3337@item --insn32
3338@kindex --no-insn32
3339@itemx --no-insn32
3340These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3341generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3342or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
334332-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3344used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3345possible.
3346
8b10b0b3
MR
3347@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3348@item --ignore-branch-isa
3349@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3350@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3351These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3352transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3353accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3354is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3355instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3356equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3357calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3358a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3359an error.
3360
3734320d
MF
3361@kindex --compact-branches
3362@item --compact-branches
3363@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3364@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3365These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3366in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3367
833794fc
MR
3368@end table
3369
3370@c man end
3371@end ifset
3372
fa1477dc
SC
3373
3374@ifset PDP11
3375@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3376
3377@c man begin OPTIONS
3378
3379For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3380produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3381for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3382targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3383defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3384here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3385
3386@table @gcctabopt
3387
3388@kindex -N
3389@item -N
3390@kindex --omagic
3391@itemx --omagic
3392
3393Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3394indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3395shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3396writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3397the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3398programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3399from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3400
3401@kindex -n
3402@item -n
3403@kindex --nmagic
3404@itemx --nmagic
3405
3406Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3407indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3408be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3409file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3410byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3411a @emph{pure executable} format.
3412
3413@kindex -z
3414@item -z
3415@kindex --imagic
3416@itemx --imagic
3417
3418Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3419indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3420data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3421instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3422larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3423to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3424shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3425option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3426and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3427this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3428executable} format.
3429
3430@kindex --no-omagic
3431@item --no-omagic
3432
3433Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3434
3435@end table
3436
3437@c man end
3438@end ifset
3439
252b5132
RH
3440@ifset UsesEnvVars
3441@node Environment
3442@section Environment Variables
3443
0285c67d
NC
3444@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3445
560e09e9 3446You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3447@ifclear SingleFormat
3448@code{GNUTARGET},
3449@end ifclear
3450@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3451
36f63dca 3452@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3453@kindex GNUTARGET
3454@cindex default input format
3455@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3456use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3457of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3458@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3459of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3460attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3461this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3462there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3463object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3464BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3465in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3466@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3467
3468@kindex LDEMULATION
3469@cindex default emulation
3470@cindex emulation, default
3471@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3472@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3473behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3474available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3475the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3476variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3477linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3478
3479@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3480@cindex demangling, default
3481Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3482@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3483default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3484a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3485may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3486options.
3487
0285c67d
NC
3488@c man end
3489@end ifset
3490
252b5132
RH
3491@node Scripts
3492@chapter Linker Scripts
3493
3494@cindex scripts
3495@cindex linker scripts
3496@cindex command files
3497Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3498written in the linker command language.
3499
3500The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3501the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3502the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3503more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3504direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3505described below.
3506
3507The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3508yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3509linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3510to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3511such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3512
3513You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3514line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3515default linker script.
3516
3517You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3518to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3519Linker Scripts}.
3520
3521@menu
3522* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3523* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3524* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3525* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3526* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3527* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3528* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3529* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3530* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3531* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3532* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3533@end menu
3534
3535@node Basic Script Concepts
3536@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3537@cindex linker script concepts
3538We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3539describe the linker script language.
3540
3541The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3542file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3543@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3544The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3545purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3546among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3547section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3548in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3549
3550Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3551also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3552contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3553the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3554A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3555area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3556loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3557which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3558of debugging information.
3559
3560Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3561first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3562the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3563@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3564section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3565same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3566is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3567(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3568based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3569RAM address would be the VMA.
3570
3571You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3572program with the @samp{-h} option.
3573
3574Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3575@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3576has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3577information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3578will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3579static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3580referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3581
3582You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3583program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3584option.
3585
3586@node Script Format
3587@section Linker Script Format
3588@cindex linker script format
3589Linker scripts are text files.
3590
3591You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3592either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3593symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3594generally ignored.
3595
3596Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3597If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3598otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3599double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3600file name.
3601
3602You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3603@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3604to whitespace.
3605
3606@node Simple Example
3607@section Simple Linker Script Example
3608@cindex linker script example
3609@cindex example of linker script
3610Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3611
3612The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3613@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3614memory layout of the output file.
3615
3616The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3617describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3618code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3619@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3620Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3621your input files.
3622
3623For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
36240x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3625linker script which will do that:
3626@smallexample
3627SECTIONS
3628@{
3629 . = 0x10000;
3630 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3631 . = 0x8000000;
3632 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3633 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3634@}
3635@end smallexample
3636
3637You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3638followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3639descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3640
252b5132
RH
3641The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3642sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3643counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3644other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3645current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3646incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3647@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3648
3649The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3650required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3651after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3652which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3653wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3654means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3655
3656Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3657@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3658@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3659
3660The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3661the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3662at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3663output section, the value of the location counter will be
3664@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3665effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3666immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3667
3668The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3669alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3670example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3671sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3672may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3673sections.
3674
3675That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3676
3677@node Simple Commands
3678@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3679@cindex linker script simple commands
3680In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3681
3682@menu
3683* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3684* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3685@ifclear SingleFormat
3686* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3687@end ifclear
3688
4a93e180 3689* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3690* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3691@end menu
3692
3693@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3694@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3695@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3696@cindex start of execution
3697@cindex first instruction
3698@cindex entry point
3699The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3700point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3701entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3702@smallexample
3703ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3704@end smallexample
3705
3706There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3707entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3708stopping when one of them succeeds:
3709@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3710@item
252b5132 3711the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3712@item
252b5132 3713the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3714@item
a094d01f 3715the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3716targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3717check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3718@item
252b5132 3719the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3720@item
252b5132
RH
3721The address @code{0}.
3722@end itemize
3723
3724@node File Commands
36f63dca 3725@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3726@cindex linker script file commands
3727Several linker script commands deal with files.
3728
3729@table @code
3730@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3731@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3732@cindex including a linker script
3733Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3734be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3735with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
373610 levels deep.
3737
4006703d
NS
3738You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3739@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3740
252b5132
RH
3741@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3742@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3743@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3744@cindex input files in linker scripts
3745@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3746@cindex linker script input object files
3747The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3748in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3749
3750For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3751a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3752then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3753
3754In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3755script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3756
e3f2db7f
AO
3757In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3758with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3759located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3760for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3761@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3762filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3763@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3764
3765If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3766the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3767found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3768not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3769path.
252b5132 3770
ff5dcc92 3771If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3772name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3773@samp{-l}.
3774
3775When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3776files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3777script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3778
3779@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3780@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3781@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3782@cindex grouping input files
3783The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3784files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3785new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3786in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3787
b717d30e
JJ
3788@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3789@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3790@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3791This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3792commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3793as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3794with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3795when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3796@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3797and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3798setting afterwards.
3799
252b5132
RH
3800@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3801@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3802@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3803The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3804@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3805@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3806Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3807precedence.
3808
3809You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3810output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3811
3812@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3813@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3814@cindex library search path in linker script
3815@cindex archive search path in linker script
3816@cindex search path in linker script
3817The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3818@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3819@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3820on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3821are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3822the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3823
3824@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3825@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3826@cindex first input file
3827The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3828that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3829though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3830when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3831first file.
3832@end table
3833
3834@ifclear SingleFormat
3835@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3836@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3837A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3838
3839@table @code
3840@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3841@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3842@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3843@cindex output file format in linker script
3844The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3845output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3846exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3847(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3848line option takes precedence.
3849
3850You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3851formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3852This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3853desired endianness.
3854
3855If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3856will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3857output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3858used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3859
3860For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3861command:
3862@smallexample
3863OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3864@end smallexample
3865This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3866@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3867option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3868format.
3869
3870@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3871@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3872@cindex input file format in linker script
3873The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3874files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3875This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3876(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
3877is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
3878command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
3879@end table
3880@end ifclear
3881
4a93e180
NC
3882@node REGION_ALIAS
3883@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
3884@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3885@cindex region alias
3886@cindex region names
3887
3888Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
3889@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
3890
3891@smallexample
3892REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
3893@end smallexample
3894
3895The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
3896memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
3897to memory regions. An example follows.
3898
3899Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
3900memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
3901that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
3902non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
3903access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
3904read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
3905sections:
3906
3907@itemize @bullet
3908@item
3909@code{.text} program code;
3910@item
3911@code{.rodata} read-only data;
3912@item
3913@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
3914@item
3915@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
3916@end itemize
3917
3918The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
3919part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
3920output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
3921systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
3922@code{C}:
3923@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
3924@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 3925@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
3926@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
3927@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
3928@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
3929@end multitable
3930The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
3931loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
3932the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
3933the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
3934
3935The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
3936includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
3937memory layout:
3938@smallexample
3939INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
3940
3941SECTIONS
3942 @{
3943 .text :
3944 @{
3945 *(.text)
3946 @} > REGION_TEXT
3947 .rodata :
3948 @{
3949 *(.rodata)
3950 rodata_end = .;
3951 @} > REGION_RODATA
3952 .data : AT (rodata_end)
3953 @{
3954 data_start = .;
3955 *(.data)
3956 @} > REGION_DATA
3957 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
3958 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
3959 .bss :
3960 @{
3961 *(.bss)
3962 @} > REGION_BSS
3963 @}
3964@end smallexample
3965
3966Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
3967regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
3968variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
3969@table @code
3970@item A
3971Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
3972@smallexample
3973MEMORY
3974 @{
3975 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
3976 @}
3977
3978REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
3979REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
3980REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3981REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3982@end smallexample
3983@item B
3984Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
3985into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
3986@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
3987@smallexample
3988MEMORY
3989 @{
3990 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
3991 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
3992 @}
3993
3994REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
3995REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
3996REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
3997REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
3998@end smallexample
3999@item C
4000Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4001@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4002initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4003system start into the @code{RAM}.
4004@smallexample
4005MEMORY
4006 @{
4007 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4008 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4009 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4010 @}
4011
4012REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4013REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4014REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4015REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4016@end smallexample
4017@end table
4018
4019It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4020@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4021necessary:
4022@smallexample
4023#include <string.h>
4024
4025extern char data_start [];
4026extern char data_size [];
4027extern char data_load_start [];
4028
4029void copy_data(void)
4030@{
4031 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4032 @{
4033 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4034 @}
4035@}
4036@end smallexample
4037
252b5132 4038@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4039@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4040There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4041
4042@table @code
4043@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4044@kindex ASSERT
4045@cindex assertion in linker script
4046Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4047with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4048
fd1c4238
NC
4049Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4050take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4051inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4052for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4053symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4054
4055@smallexample
4056 .stack :
4057 @{
4058 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4059 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4060 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4061 @}
4062@end smallexample
4063
4064will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4065PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4066can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4067
4068@smallexample
4069 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4070 .stack :
4071 @{
4072 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4073 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4074 @}
4075@end smallexample
4076
4077will work.
4078
252b5132
RH
4079@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4080@kindex EXTERN
4081@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4082Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4083symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4084modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4085each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4086command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4087
4088@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4089@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4090@cindex common allocation in linker script
4091This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4092to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4093output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4094
4818e05f
AM
4095@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4096@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4097@cindex common allocation in linker script
4098This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4099command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4100to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4101
7bdf4127
AB
4102@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4103@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4104@cindex group allocation in linker script
4105@cindex section groups
4106@cindex COMDAT
4107This command has the same effect as the
4108@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4109@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4110and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4111specified (@samp{-r}).
4112
53d25da6
AM
4113@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4114@kindex INSERT
4115@cindex insert user script into default script
4116This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4117augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4118inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4119@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4120default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4121sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4122linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4123insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4124linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4125default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4126of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4127to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4128is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4129
4130@smallexample
4131SECTIONS
4132@{
4133 OVERLAY :
4134 @{
4135 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4136 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4137 @}
4138@}
4139INSERT AFTER .text;
4140@end smallexample
4141
252b5132
RH
4142@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4143@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4144@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4145This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4146references among certain output sections.
4147
4148In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4149using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4150will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4151errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4152a function defined in the other section.
4153
4154The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4155@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4156an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4157@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4158names.
4159
cdf96953
MF
4160@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4161@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4162@cindex cross references
4163This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4164references to one section from a list of other sections.
4165
4166The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4167output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4168a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4169there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4170must never call back.
4171
4172The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4173The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4174If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4175the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4176status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4177names, not input section names.
4178
252b5132
RH
4179@ifclear SingleFormat
4180@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4181@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4182@cindex machine architecture
4183@cindex architecture
4184Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4185of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4186architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4187the @samp{-f} option.
4188@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4189
4190@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4191@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4192This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4193@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4194in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4195@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4196@end table
4197
4198@node Assignments
4199@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4200@cindex assignment in scripts
4201@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4202@cindex variables, defining
4203You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4204the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4205
4206@menu
4207* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4208* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4209* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4210* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4211* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4212@end menu
4213
4214@node Simple Assignments
4215@subsection Simple Assignments
4216
4217You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4218
4219@table @code
4220@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4221@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4222@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4223@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4224@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4225@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4226@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4227@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4228@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4229@end table
4230
4231The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4232@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4233defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4234
4235The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4236may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4237
4238The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4239
4240Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4241
4242You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4243statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4244section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4245
4246The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4247expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4248
4249Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4250assignments may be used:
4251
4252@smallexample
4253floating_point = 0;
4254SECTIONS
4255@{
4256 .text :
4257 @{
4258 *(.text)
4259 _etext = .;
4260 @}
156e34dd 4261 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4262 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4263@}
4264@end smallexample
4265@noindent
4266In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4267zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4268the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4269defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4270upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4271
eb8476a6
MR
4272@node HIDDEN
4273@subsection HIDDEN
4274@cindex HIDDEN
4275For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4276exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4277
4278Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4279@code{HIDDEN}:
4280
4281@smallexample
4282HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4283SECTIONS
4284@{
4285 .text :
4286 @{
4287 *(.text)
4288 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4289 @}
4290 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4291 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4292@}
4293@end smallexample
4294@noindent
4295In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4296
252b5132
RH
4297@node PROVIDE
4298@subsection PROVIDE
4299@cindex PROVIDE
4300In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4301only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4302the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4303@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4304@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4305@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4306@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4307@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4308
4309Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4310@smallexample
4311SECTIONS
4312@{
4313 .text :
4314 @{
4315 *(.text)
4316 _etext = .;
4317 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4318 @}
4319@}
4320@end smallexample
4321
4322In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4323underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4324the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4325underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4326If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4327linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4328
b0daac83
NC
4329Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4330defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4331that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4332when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4333@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4334
7af8e998
L
4335@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4336@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4337@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4338Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4339hidden and won't be exported.
4340
73ae6183
NC
4341@node Source Code Reference
4342@subsection Source Code Reference
4343
4344Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4345intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4346a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4347symbol that does not have a value.
4348
4349Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4350transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4351stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4352prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4353mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4354of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4355variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4356linker script variable might be referred to as:
4357
4358@smallexample
4359 extern int foo;
4360@end smallexample
4361
4362But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4363
4364@smallexample
4365 _foo = 1000;
4366@end smallexample
4367
4368In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4369transformation has taken place.
4370
4371When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4372things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4373in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4374second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4375table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4376contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4377value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4378
4379@smallexample
4380 int foo = 1000;
4381@end smallexample
4382
10bf6894 4383creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4384holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4385number 1000 is initially stored.
4386
4387When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4388first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4389memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4390So:
4391
4392@smallexample
4393 foo = 1;
4394@end smallexample
4395
4396looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4397associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4398address. Whereas:
4399
4400@smallexample
4401 int * a = & foo;
4402@end smallexample
4403
10bf6894 4404looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4405and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4406the variable @samp{a}.
4407
4408Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4409the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4410an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4411
4412@smallexample
4413 foo = 1000;
4414@end smallexample
4415
4416creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4417the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4418address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4419linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4420access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4421
4422Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4423you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4424use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4425section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4426linker script contains these declarations:
4427
4428@smallexample
4429@group
4430 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4431 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4432 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4433@end group
4434@end smallexample
4435
4436Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4437
4438@smallexample
4439@group
4440 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4441
73ae6183
NC
4442 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4443@end group
4444@end smallexample
4445
4446Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4447Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4448arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4449
4450@smallexample
4451@group
4452 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4453
4454 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4455@end group
4456@end smallexample
4457
4458Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4459operators.
73ae6183 4460
252b5132 4461@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4462@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4463@kindex SECTIONS
4464The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4465into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4466
4467The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4468@smallexample
4469SECTIONS
4470@{
4471 @var{sections-command}
4472 @var{sections-command}
4473 @dots{}
4474@}
4475@end smallexample
4476
4477Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4478
4479@itemize @bullet
4480@item
4481an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4482@item
4483a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4484@item
4485an output section description
4486@item
4487an overlay description
4488@end itemize
4489
4490The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4491@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4492those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4493understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4494the layout of the output file.
4495
4496Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4497below.
4498
4499If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4500linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4501section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4502input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4503example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4504in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4505
4506@menu
4507* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4508* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4509* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4510* Input Section:: Input section description
4511* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4512* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4513* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4514* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4515* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4516@end menu
4517
4518@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4519@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4520The full description of an output section looks like this:
4521@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4522@group
7e7d5768 4523@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4524 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4525 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4526 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4527 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4528 @{
4529 @var{output-section-command}
4530 @var{output-section-command}
4531 @dots{}
abc9061b 4532 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4533@end group
4534@end smallexample
4535
4536Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4537
4538The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4539name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4540The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4541the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4542The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4543
4544Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4545
4546@itemize @bullet
4547@item
4548a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4549@item
4550an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4551@item
4552data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4553@item
4554a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4555@end itemize
4556
4557@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4558@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4559@cindex name, section
4560@cindex section name
4561The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4562meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4563support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4564must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4565example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4566output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4567names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4568quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4569characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4570commas must be quoted.
4571
4572The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4573Discarding}.
4574
4575@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4576@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4577@cindex address, section
4578@cindex section address
4579The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4580address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4581is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4582
4583If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4584section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4585to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4586alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4587contained within the output section.
4588
4589The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4590
4591@itemize @bullet
4592@item
4593If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4594is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4595in that region.
4596
4597@item
4598If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4599regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4600section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4601be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4602
4603@item
4604If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4605the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4606counter.
4607@end itemize
4608
4609@noindent
4610For example:
4611
252b5132
RH
4612@smallexample
4613.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4614@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4615
252b5132
RH
4616@noindent
4617and
ea5cae92 4618
252b5132
RH
4619@smallexample
4620.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4621@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4622
252b5132
RH
4623@noindent
4624are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4625@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4626counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4627counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4628input sections.
252b5132
RH
4629
4630The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4631For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4632so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4633do something like this:
4634@smallexample
4635.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4636@end smallexample
4637@noindent
4638This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4639aligned upward to the specified value.
4640
4641Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4642location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4643sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4644
4645@node Input Section
36f63dca 4646@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4647@cindex input sections
4648@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4649The most common output section command is an input section description.
4650
4651The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4652You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4653in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4654map the input files into your memory layout.
4655
4656@menu
4657* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4658* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4659* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4660* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4661* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4662@end menu
4663
4664@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4665@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4666@cindex input section basics
4667An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4668by a list of section names in parentheses.
4669
4670The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4671describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4672
4673The most common input section description is to include all input
4674sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4675include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4676@smallexample
4677*(.text)
4678@end smallexample
4679@noindent
18625d54 4680Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4681@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4682of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4683match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4684example:
252b5132 4685@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4686EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4687@end smallexample
4688@noindent
4689will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4690and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4691placed inside the section list, for example:
4692@smallexample
b4346c09 4693*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4694@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4695@noindent
4696The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4697two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4698more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4699
4700There are two ways to include more than one section:
4701@smallexample
4702*(.text .rdata)
4703*(.text) *(.rdata)
4704@end smallexample
4705@noindent
4706The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4707@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4708first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4709they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4710@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4711@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4712
8f1732fc
AB
4713When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4714is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4715immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4716@smallexample
4717*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4718@end smallexample
4719@noindent
4720will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4721@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4722from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4723exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4724could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4725@smallexample
4726*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4727@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4728@noindent
4729Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4730before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4731all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4732@smallexample
4733EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4734@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4735
252b5132
RH
4736You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4737You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4738needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4739@smallexample
4740data.o(.data)
4741@end smallexample
4742
ae17ab41
CM
4743To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4744of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4745
4746Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4747
4748@smallexample
4749@group
4750SECTIONS @{
4751 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4752 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4753@}
4754@end group
4755@end smallexample
4756
4757In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4758input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4759@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4760@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4761whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4762
967928e9
AM
4763You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4764matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4765with no whitespace around the colon.
4766
4767@table @samp
4768@item archive:file
4769matches file within archive
4770@item archive:
4771matches the whole archive
4772@item :file
4773matches file but not one in an archive
4774@end table
4775
4776Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4777wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4778single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4779@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4780within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4781also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4782other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4783from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4784command.
4785
252b5132
RH
4786If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4787the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4788commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4789@smallexample
4790data.o
4791@end smallexample
4792
967928e9
AM
4793When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4794and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4795characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4796name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4797did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4798though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4799@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4800the archive search path.
4801
4802@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4803@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4804@cindex input section wildcards
4805@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4806@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4807@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4808In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4809name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4810
4811The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4812pattern for the file name.
4813
4814The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4815
4816@table @samp
4817@item *
4818matches any number of characters
4819@item ?
4820matches any single character
4821@item [@var{chars}]
4822matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4823character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4824@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4825@item \
4826quotes the following character
4827@end table
4828
4829When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4830will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4831Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4832exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4833@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4834a @samp{/} character.
4835
4836File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4837specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4838does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4839
4840If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4841appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4842will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4843sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4844@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4845@smallexample
4846.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4847.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4848@end smallexample
4849
bcaa7b3e 4850@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4851Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4852in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4853this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4854pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4855@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4856into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4857
bcaa7b3e 4858@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4859@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4860@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4861alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4862alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4863needed.
bcaa7b3e 4864
02ecc8e9 4865@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4866@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4867@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4868numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4869section name before placing them in the output file. In
4870@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4871the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4872@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4873
bcaa7b3e
L
4874@cindex SORT
4875@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4876
4877When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
4878can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
4879
4880@enumerate
4881@item
4882@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4883It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4884sections have the same name.
4885@item
4886@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 4887It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
4888sections have the same alignment.
4889@item
c0065db7 4890@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
4891treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
4892@item
4893@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
4894is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
4895@item
4896All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
4897@end enumerate
4898
a05a5b64 4899When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 4900section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 4901takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
4902
4903If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 4904command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
4905treated as nested sorting command.
4906
4907@enumerate
4908@item
4909@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
4910@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
4911@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
4912@item
4913@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
4914@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
4915@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
4916@end enumerate
4917
4918If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 4919command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 4920
eda680f8 4921@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 4922@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
4923section sorting option.
4924
252b5132
RH
4925If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
4926@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
4927precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
4928
4929This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
4930files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
4931sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
4932The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
4933with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
4934linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
4935@smallexample
4936@group
4937SECTIONS @{
4938 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4939 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
4940 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4941 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4942@}
4943@end group
4944@end smallexample
4945
4946@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 4947@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
4948@cindex common symbol placement
4949@cindex uninitialized data placement
4950A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
4951file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
4952linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
4953named @samp{COMMON}.
4954
4955You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
4956other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
4957particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
4958input files are placed in another section.
4959
4960In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
4961@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
4962@smallexample
4963.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
4964@end smallexample
4965
4966@cindex scommon section
4967@cindex small common symbols
4968Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
4969example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
4970symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
4971different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
4972the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
4973symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
4974to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
4975locations.
4976
4977@cindex [COMMON]
4978You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
4979notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
4980@samp{*(COMMON)}.
4981
4982@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 4983@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
4984@cindex KEEP
4985@cindex garbage collection
4986When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 4987it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
4988This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
4989with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 4990@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
4991
4992@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 4993@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
4994The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
4995to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
4996start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
4997@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
4998follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
4999@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5000@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5001All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5002files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5003
5004@smallexample
5005@group
5006SECTIONS @{
5007 outputa 0x10000 :
5008 @{
5009 all.o
5010 foo.o (.input1)
5011 @}
36f63dca
NC
5012@end group
5013@group
252b5132
RH
5014 outputb :
5015 @{
5016 foo.o (.input2)
5017 foo1.o (.input1)
5018 @}
36f63dca
NC
5019@end group
5020@group
252b5132
RH
5021 outputc :
5022 @{
5023 *(.input1)
5024 *(.input2)
5025 @}
5026@}
5027@end group
a1ab1d2a 5028@end smallexample
252b5132 5029
cbd0eecf
L
5030If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5031and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5032automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5033__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5034indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5035respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5036C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5037
252b5132 5038@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5039@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5040@cindex data
5041@cindex section data
5042@cindex output section data
5043@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5044@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5045@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5046@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5047@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5048You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5049@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5050an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5051parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5052value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5053counter.
5054
5055The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5056store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5057bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5058stored.
5059
5060For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5061of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5062@smallexample
5063BYTE(1)
5064LONG(addr)
5065@end smallexample
5066
5067When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5068same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5069target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5070@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5071@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5072
5073If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5074which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5075When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5076true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5077endianness of the first input object file.
5078
36f63dca 5079Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5080between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5081@smallexample
5082SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5083@end smallexample
5084whereas this will work:
5085@smallexample
5086SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5087@end smallexample
5088
252b5132
RH
5089@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5090@cindex holes, filling
5091@cindex unspecified memory
5092You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5093current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5094otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5095gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5096with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5097necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5098point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5099than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5100different parts of an output section.
5101
5102This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5103value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5104@smallexample
563e308f 5105FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5106@end smallexample
5107
5108The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5109section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5110part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5111entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5112precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5113expression.
252b5132
RH
5114
5115@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5116@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5117There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5118commands.
5119
5120@table @code
5121@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5122@cindex input filename symbols
5123@cindex filename symbols
5124@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5125The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5126The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5127file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5128the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5129
5130This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5131normally used for any other object file format.
5132
5133@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5134@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5135@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5136@item CONSTRUCTORS
5137When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5138unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5139destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5140arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5141automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5142For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5143linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5144@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5145ignored for other object file formats.
5146
5147The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5148constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5149Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5150the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5151first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5152of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5153compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5154formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5155@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5156the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5157destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5158@code{exit}.
5159
5160For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5161arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5162addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5163and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5164linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5165runtime code expects to see.
5166
5167@smallexample
5168 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5169 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5170 *(.ctors)
5171 LONG(0)
5172 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5173 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5174 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5175 *(.dtors)
5176 LONG(0)
5177 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5178@end smallexample
5179
5180If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5181which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5182are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5183are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5184command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5185@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5186@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5187@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5188
5189Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5190and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5191need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5192scripts.
5193
5194@end table
5195
5196@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5197@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5198@cindex discarding sections
5199@cindex sections, discarding
5200@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5201The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5202This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5203may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5204@smallexample
49c13adb 5205.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5206@end smallexample
5207@noindent
5208will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5209@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5210sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5211space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5212too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5213space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5214@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5215@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5216This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5217
a0976ea4 5218The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5219on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5220symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5221the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5222section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5223
5224@cindex /DISCARD/
5225The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5226input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5227section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5228
a2e098c3
NC
5229Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5230discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5231members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5232Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5233
252b5132 5234@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5235@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5236@cindex output section attributes
5237We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5238like this:
0c71d759 5239
252b5132 5240@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5241@group
7e7d5768 5242@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5243 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5244 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5245 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5246 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5247 @{
5248 @var{output-section-command}
5249 @var{output-section-command}
5250 @dots{}
562d3460 5251 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5252@end group
5253@end smallexample
0c71d759 5254
252b5132
RH
5255We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5256@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5257remaining section attributes.
5258
a1ab1d2a 5259@menu
252b5132
RH
5260* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5261* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5262* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5263* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5264* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5265* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5266* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5267* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5268@end menu
5269
5270@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5271@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5272Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5273parentheses. The following types are defined:
5274
5275@table @code
5276@item NOLOAD
5277The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5278loaded into memory when the program is run.
5279@item DSECT
5280@itemx COPY
5281@itemx INFO
5282@itemx OVERLAY
5283These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5284rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5285marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5286section when the program is run.
5287@end table
5288
5289@kindex NOLOAD
5290@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5291@cindex loading, preventing
5292The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5293the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5294the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5295@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5296need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5297@smallexample
5298@group
5299SECTIONS @{
5300 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5301 @dots{}
5302@}
5303@end group
5304@end smallexample
5305
5306@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5307@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5308@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5309@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5310@cindex load address
5311@cindex section load address
5312Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5313@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5314@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5315specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5316address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5317
ea5cae92
NC
5318The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5319specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5320takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5321load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5322region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5323
5324If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5325section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5326load address:
5327
5328@itemize @bullet
5329@item
5330If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5331the LMA address as well.
5332
5333@item
5334If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5335
5336@item
5337Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5338with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5339section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5340VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5341the last section in the located region.
5342
5343@item
5344If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5345that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5346
5347@item
5348If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5349section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5350@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5351
5352@cindex ROM initialized data
5353@cindex initialized data in ROM
5354This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5355example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5356called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5357@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5358even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5359uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5360defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5361counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5362
5363@smallexample
5364@group
5365SECTIONS
5366 @{
5367 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5368 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5369 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5370 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5371 .bss 0x3000 :
5372 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5373@}
5374@end group
5375@end smallexample
5376
5377The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5378this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5379the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5380how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5381script.
5382
5383@smallexample
5384@group
5385extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5386char *src = &_etext;
5387char *dst = &_data;
5388
ea5cae92
NC
5389/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5390while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5391 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5392
ea5cae92 5393/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5394for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5395 *dst = 0;
5396@end group
5397@end smallexample
5398
bbf115d3
L
5399@node Forced Output Alignment
5400@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5401@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5402@cindex forcing output section alignment
5403@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5404You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5405alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5406intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5407
7e7d5768
AM
5408@node Forced Input Alignment
5409@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5410@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5411@cindex forcing input section alignment
5412@cindex input section alignment
5413You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5414SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5415sections, whether larger or smaller.
5416
0c71d759
NC
5417@node Output Section Constraint
5418@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5419@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5420@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5421@cindex constraints on output sections
5422You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5423of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5424read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5425@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5426
252b5132 5427@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5428@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5429@kindex >@var{region}
5430@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5431@cindex memory regions and sections
5432You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5433using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5434
5435Here is a simple example:
5436@smallexample
5437@group
5438MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5439SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5440@end group
5441@end smallexample
5442
5443@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5444@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5445@kindex :@var{phdr}
5446@cindex section, assigning to program header
5447@cindex program headers and sections
5448You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5449using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5450one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5451assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5452@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5453linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5454
5455Here is a simple example:
5456@smallexample
5457@group
5458PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5459SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5460@end group
5461@end smallexample
5462
5463@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5464@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5465@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5466@cindex section fill pattern
5467@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5468You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5469@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5470(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5471within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5472alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5473necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5474of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5475an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5476fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5477other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5478pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5479expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5480
5481You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5482output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5483
5484Here is a simple example:
5485@smallexample
5486@group
563e308f 5487SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5488@end group
5489@end smallexample
5490
5491@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5492@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5493@kindex OVERLAY
5494@cindex overlays
5495An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5496are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5497the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5498copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5499required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5500can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5501than another.
5502
5503Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5504@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5505output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5506command is as follows:
5507@smallexample
5508@group
5509OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5510 @{
5511 @var{secname1}
5512 @{
5513 @var{output-section-command}
5514 @var{output-section-command}
5515 @dots{}
5516 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5517 @var{secname2}
5518 @{
5519 @var{output-section-command}
5520 @var{output-section-command}
5521 @dots{}
5522 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5523 @dots{}
abc9061b 5524 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5525@end group
5526@end smallexample
5527
5528Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5529section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5530section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5531those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5532except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5533sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5534
abc9061b
CC
5535The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5536the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5537
252b5132
RH
5538The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5539addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5540memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5541whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5542and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5543and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5544
56dd11f0
NC
5545If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5546references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5547the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5548sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5549@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5550
5551For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5552provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5553defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5554@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5555the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5556within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5557symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5558
5559At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5560the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5561
5562Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5563@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5564@smallexample
5565@group
5566 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5567 @{
5568 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5569 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5570 @}
5571@end group
5572@end smallexample
5573@noindent
5574This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5575address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5576@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5577following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5578@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5579@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5580
5581C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5582like the following.
5583
5584@smallexample
5585@group
5586 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5587 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5588 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5589@end group
5590@end smallexample
5591
5592Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5593everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5594example could have been written identically as follows.
5595
5596@smallexample
5597@group
5598 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5599 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5600 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5601 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5602 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5603 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5604 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5605@end group
5606@end smallexample
5607
5608@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5609@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5610@kindex MEMORY
5611@cindex memory regions
5612@cindex regions of memory
5613@cindex allocating memory
5614@cindex discontinuous memory
5615The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5616memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5617
5618The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5619memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5620may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5621can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5622set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5623regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5624around to fit into the available regions.
5625
127fcdff
AB
5626A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5627however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5628specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5629@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5630@smallexample
5631@group
a1ab1d2a 5632MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5633 @{
5634 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5635 @dots{}
5636 @}
5637@end group
5638@end smallexample
5639
5640The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5641region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5642Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5643with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5644must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5645add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5646command.
252b5132
RH
5647
5648@cindex memory region attributes
5649The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5650whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5651not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5652@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5653section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5654the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5655them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5656
5657The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5658@table @samp
5659@item R
5660Read-only section
5661@item W
5662Read/write section
5663@item X
5664Executable section
5665@item A
5666Allocatable section
5667@item I
5668Initialized section
5669@item L
5670Same as @samp{I}
5671@item !
c09e9a8c 5672Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5673@end table
5674
81c688d5 5675If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5676@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5677attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5678unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5679not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5680string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5681or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5682the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5683
5684@kindex ORIGIN =
5685@kindex o =
5686@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5687The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5688the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5689cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5690abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5691@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5692
5693@kindex LENGTH =
5694@kindex len =
5695@kindex l =
5696The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5697region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5698be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5699@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5700
5701In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5702available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5703and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5704linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5705is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5706or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5707explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5708region.
5709
5710@smallexample
5711@group
a1ab1d2a 5712MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5713 @{
5714 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5715 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5716 @}
5717@end group
5718@end smallexample
5719
5720Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5721specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5722@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5723a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5724output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5725was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5726the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5727output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5728region, the linker will issue an error message.
5729
3ec57632 5730It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5731expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5732@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5733
5734@smallexample
5735@group
c0065db7 5736 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5737@end group
5738@end smallexample
5739
252b5132
RH
5740@node PHDRS
5741@section PHDRS Command
5742@kindex PHDRS
5743@cindex program headers
5744@cindex ELF program headers
5745@cindex program segments
5746@cindex segments, ELF
5747The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5748@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5749loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5750program with the @samp{-p} option.
5751
5752When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5753reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5754program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5755This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5756interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5757
5758The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5759in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5760precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5761the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5762not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5763
5764The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5765generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5766ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5767
5768This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5769@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5770
5771@smallexample
5772@group
5773PHDRS
5774@{
5775 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5776 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5777@}
5778@end group
5779@end smallexample
5780
5781The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5782of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5783header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5784with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5785must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5786is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5787
5788Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5789system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5790specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5791sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5792attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5793Section Phdr}.
5794
5795It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5796merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5797repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5798contain the section.
5799
5800If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5801then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5802not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5803convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5804placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5805default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5806segment at all.
5807
5808@kindex FILEHDR
5809@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5810You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5811the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5812The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5813file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5814include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5815segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5816these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5817
5818The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5819value of the keyword.
5820
5821@table @asis
5822@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5823Indicates an unused program header.
5824
5825@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5826Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5827the file.
5828
5829@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5830Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5831
5832@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5833Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5834found.
5835
5836@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5837Indicates a segment holding note information.
5838
5839@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5840A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5841ABI.
5842
5843@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5844Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5845
1a9ccd70
NC
5846@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5847Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5848
252b5132
RH
5849@item @var{expression}
5850An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5851be used for types not defined above.
5852@end table
5853
5854You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5855in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5856@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5857Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5858output section attribute.
5859
5860The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5861which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5862explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5863an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5864header.
5865
5866Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5867headers used on a native ELF system.
5868
5869@example
5870@group
5871PHDRS
5872@{
5873 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
5874 interp PT_INTERP ;
5875 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
5876 data PT_LOAD ;
5877 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
5878@}
5879
5880SECTIONS
5881@{
5882 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
5883 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
5884 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
5885 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
5886 @dots{}
5887 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
5888 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
5889 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
5890 @dots{}
5891@}
5892@end group
5893@end example
5894
5895@node VERSION
5896@section VERSION Command
5897@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
5898@cindex symbol versions
5899@cindex version script
5900@cindex versions of symbols
5901The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
5902only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
5903symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
5904a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
5905shared library.
5906
5907You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
5908you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
5909also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
5910
5911The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
5912@smallexample
5913VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
5914@end smallexample
5915
5916The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
5917Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
5918version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
5919version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
5920version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
5921scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
5922library.
5923
5924The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
5925examples.
5926
5927@smallexample
5928VERS_1.1 @{
5929 global:
5930 foo1;
5931 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
5932 old*;
5933 original*;
5934 new*;
252b5132
RH
5935@};
5936
5937VERS_1.2 @{
5938 foo2;
5939@} VERS_1.1;
5940
5941VERS_2.0 @{
5942 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 5943 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 5944 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
5945 "f(int, double)";
5946 @};
252b5132
RH
5947@} VERS_1.2;
5948@end smallexample
5949
5950This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
5951version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
5952The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
5953a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
5954of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
5955symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
5956is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
5957in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
5958However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
5959name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
5960
5961Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
5962depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
5963to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
5964
5965Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
5966depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
5967and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
5968
5969When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
5970specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
5971unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 5972unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
5973somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
5974wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
5975wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
5976set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
5977ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
5978
5979The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
5980they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
5981could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
5982However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
5983
0f6bf451 5984Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
5985in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
5986symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
5987won't.
5988
5989@smallexample
7c9c73be 5990@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 5991@end smallexample
6b9b879a 5992
252b5132
RH
5993When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
5994symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
5995requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
5996shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
5997loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
5998linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
5999application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6000way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6001all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6002search for each symbol reference.
6003
6004The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6005doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6006that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6007functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6008the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6009required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6010that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6011versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6012the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6013
6014There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6015first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6016source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6017script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6018maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6019@smallexample
6020__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6021@end smallexample
6022@noindent
6023in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6024be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6025The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6026@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6027takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6028
6029The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6030function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6031an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6032version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6033linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6034
6035To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6036source file. Here is an example:
6037
6038@smallexample
6039__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6040__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6041__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6042__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6043@end smallexample
6044
6045In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6046unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6047example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6048@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6049
6050When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6051some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6052this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6053@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6054declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6055you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6056
6057If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6058within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6059(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6060specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6061
cb840a31
L
6062You can also specify the language in the version script:
6063
6064@smallexample
6065VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6066@end smallexample
6067
c0065db7 6068The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6069The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6070demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6071patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6072@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6073
86043bbb
MM
6074Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6075described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6076or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6077the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6078whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6079cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6080might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6081should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6082expect when you upgrade.
6083
252b5132
RH
6084@node Expressions
6085@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6086@cindex expressions
6087@cindex arithmetic
6088The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6089that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6090expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6091host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6092
6093You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6094
6095The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6096expressions.
6097
6098@menu
6099* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6100* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6101* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6102* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6103* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6104* Operators:: Operators
6105* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6106* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6107* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6108@end menu
6109
6110@node Constants
6111@subsection Constants
6112@cindex integer notation
6113@cindex constants in linker scripts
6114All constants are integers.
6115
6116As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6117octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6118hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6119@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6120@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6121value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6122
6123@cindex scaled integers
6124@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6125@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6126@cindex suffixes for integers
6127@cindex integer suffixes
6128In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6129constant by
6130@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6131@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6132@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6133@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6134@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6135@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6136@tex
6137${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6138@end tex
6139@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6140respectively. For example, the following
6141all refer to the same quantity:
6142
252b5132 6143@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6144_fourk_1 = 4K;
6145_fourk_2 = 4096;
6146_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6147_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6148@end smallexample
6149
8a308ae8
NC
6150Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6151conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6152
0c71d759
NC
6153@node Symbolic Constants
6154@subsection Symbolic Constants
6155@cindex symbolic constants
6156@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6157It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6158the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6159
6160@table @code
6161@item MAXPAGESIZE
6162@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6163The target's maximum page size.
6164
6165@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6166@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6167The target's default page size.
6168@end table
6169
6170So for example:
6171
6172@smallexample
9d5777a3 6173 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6174@end smallexample
6175
6176will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6177supported by the target.
6178
252b5132
RH
6179@node Symbols
6180@subsection Symbol Names
6181@cindex symbol names
6182@cindex names
6183@cindex quoted symbol names
6184@kindex "
6185Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6186and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6187Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6188specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6189keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6190@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6191"SECTION" = 9;
6192"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6193@end smallexample
6194
6195Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6196to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6197whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6198
ecca9871
L
6199@node Orphan Sections
6200@subsection Orphan Sections
6201@cindex orphan
6202Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6203are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6204script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6205output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6206in which to place the orphaned input section.
6207
6208If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6209an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6210placed at the end of that output section.
6211
6212If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6213sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6214name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6215orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6216one new output section.
6217
6218If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6219then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6220in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6221linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6222attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6223sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6224support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6225
a05a5b64
TP
6226The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6227(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6228output sections an orphan is placed in.
6229
252b5132
RH
6230@node Location Counter
6231@subsection The Location Counter
6232@kindex .
6233@cindex dot
6234@cindex location counter
6235@cindex current output location
6236The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6237current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6238location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6239within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6240anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6241
6242@cindex holes
6243Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6244moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6245location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6246and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6247doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6248
6249@smallexample
6250SECTIONS
6251@{
6252 output :
6253 @{
6254 file1(.text)
6255 . = . + 1000;
6256 file2(.text)
6257 . += 1000;
6258 file3(.text)
563e308f 6259 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6260@}
6261@end smallexample
6262@noindent
6263In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6264located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6265followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6266@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6267@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6268specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6269
5c6bbab8
NC
6270@cindex dot inside sections
6271Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6272current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6273statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6274absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6275however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6276not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6277
6278@smallexample
6279SECTIONS
6280@{
6281 . = 0x100
6282 .text: @{
6283 *(.text)
6284 . = 0x200
6285 @}
6286 . = 0x500
6287 .data: @{
6288 *(.data)
6289 . += 0x600
6290 @}
6291@}
6292@end smallexample
6293
6294The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6295and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6296the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6297much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6298move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6299and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6300the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6301the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6302
b5666f2f
AM
6303@cindex dot outside sections
6304Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6305output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6306needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6307
6308@smallexample
6309SECTIONS
6310@{
6311 start_of_text = . ;
6312 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6313 end_of_text = . ;
6314
6315 start_of_data = . ;
6316 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6317 end_of_data = . ;
6318@}
6319@end smallexample
6320
6321If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6322not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6323between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6324should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6325blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6326the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6327sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6328statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6329special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6330place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6331as follows:
6332
6333@smallexample
6334SECTIONS
6335@{
6336 start_of_text = . ;
6337 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6338 end_of_text = . ;
6339
6340 start_of_data = . ;
6341 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6342 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6343 end_of_data = . ;
6344@}
6345@end smallexample
6346
6347This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6348@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6349placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6350assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6351a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6352section. So you could write:
6353
6354@smallexample
6355SECTIONS
6356@{
6357 start_of_text = . ;
6358 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6359 end_of_text = . ;
6360
6361 . = . ;
6362 start_of_data = . ;
6363 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6364 end_of_data = . ;
6365@}
6366@end smallexample
6367
6368Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6369@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6370
252b5132
RH
6371@need 2000
6372@node Operators
6373@subsection Operators
6374@cindex operators for arithmetic
6375@cindex arithmetic operators
6376@cindex precedence in expressions
6377The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6378the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6379@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6380@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6381@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6382@smallexample
6383precedence associativity Operators Notes
6384(highest)
63851 left ! - ~ (1)
63862 left * / %
63873 left + -
63884 left >> <<
63895 left == != > < <= >=
63906 left &
63917 left |
63928 left &&
63939 left ||
639410 right ? :
639511 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6396(lowest)
6397@end smallexample
6398Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6399(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6400(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6401@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6402@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6403@tex
6404\vskip \baselineskip
6405%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6406\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6407\hrule
6408\halign
6409{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6410height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6411&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6412height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6413\noalign{\hrule}
6414height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6415&highest&&&&&\cr
6416% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6417&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6418&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6419&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6420&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6421&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6422&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6423&7&&left&&|&\cr
6424&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6425&9&&left&&||&\cr
6426&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6427&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6428&lowest&&&&&\cr
6429height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6430\hrule}
6431@end tex
6432@iftex
6433{
6434@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6435@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6436@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6437}
6438@end iftex
6439@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6440
6441@node Evaluation
6442@subsection Evaluation
6443@cindex lazy evaluation
6444@cindex expression evaluation order
6445The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6446an expression when absolutely necessary.
6447
6448The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6449address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6450regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6451as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6452
6453However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6454until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6455other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6456for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6457
6458The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6459assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6460allocation.
6461
6462Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6463@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6464
6465If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6466available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6467following
6468@smallexample
6469@group
6470SECTIONS
6471 @{
a1ab1d2a 6472 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6473 @{ *(.text) @}
6474 @}
6475@end group
6476@end smallexample
6477@noindent
6478will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6479address}.
6480
6481@node Expression Section
6482@subsection The Section of an Expression
6483@cindex expression sections
6484@cindex absolute expressions
6485@cindex relative expressions
6486@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6487@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6488@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6489Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6490relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6491using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6492value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6493symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6494operations.
6495
abf4be64
AM
6496Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6497section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6498address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6499@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6500functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6501One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6502(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6503differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6504versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6505section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6506Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6507absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6508given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6509everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6510
6511In the following simple example,
252b5132 6512
7542af2a
AM
6513@smallexample
6514@group
6515SECTIONS
6516 @{
6517 . = 0x100;
6518 __executable_start = 0x100;
6519 .data :
6520 @{
6521 . = 0x10;
6522 __data_start = 0x10;
6523 *(.data)
6524 @}
6525 @dots{}
6526 @}
6527@end group
6528@end smallexample
252b5132 6529
7542af2a
AM
6530both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6531address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6532@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6533section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6534
5c3049d2
AM
6535For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6536addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6537
6538@itemize @bullet
6539@item
c05f749e
AM
6540Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6541operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6542absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6543@item
7542af2a
AM
6544Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6545relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6546and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6547@item
c05f749e
AM
6548Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6549in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6550address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6551before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6552@end itemize
6553
6554The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6555
6556@itemize @bullet
6557@item
6558An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6559@item
6560The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6561@item
9bc8bb33 6562The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6563relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6564(after above conversions) is also a number when
6565@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6566but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6567@item
6568The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6569relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6570section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6571@item
6572The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6573conversions) is an absolute address.
6574@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6575
6576You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6577to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6578create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6579section @samp{.data}:
6580@smallexample
6581SECTIONS
6582 @{
6583 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6584 @}
6585@end smallexample
6586@noindent
6587If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6588@samp{.data} section.
6589
7542af2a
AM
6590Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6591particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6592
252b5132
RH
6593@node Builtin Functions
6594@subsection Builtin Functions
6595@cindex functions in expressions
6596The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6597use in linker script expressions.
6598
6599@table @code
6600@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6601@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6602@cindex expression, absolute
6603Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6604of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6605value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6606normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6607
6608@item ADDR(@var{section})
6609@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6610@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6611Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6612script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6613the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6614@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6615@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6616the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6617@smallexample
6618@group
6619SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6620 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6621 @{
252b5132
RH
6622 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6623 @dots{}
6624 @}
6625 .output :
6626 @{
6627 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6628 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6629 @}
6630@dots{} @}
6631@end group
6632@end smallexample
6633
876f4090
NS
6634@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6635@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6636@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6637@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6638@cindex round up location counter
6639@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6640@cindex round up expression
6641@cindex align expression
6642Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6643to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6644doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6645arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6646expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6647equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6648
6649Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6650next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6651variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6652input sections:
252b5132
RH
6653@smallexample
6654@group
6655SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6656 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6657 *(.data)
6658 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6659 @}
6660@dots{} @}
6661@end group
6662@end smallexample
6663@noindent
6664The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6665a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6666a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6667of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6668
6669The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6670
362c1d1a
NS
6671@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6672@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6673@cindex section alignment
6674Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6675been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6676evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6677the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6678value in that section.
6679@smallexample
6680@group
6681SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6682 .output @{
6683 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6684 @dots{}
6685 @}
6686@dots{} @}
6687@end group
6688@end smallexample
6689
252b5132
RH
6690@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6691@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6692This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6693scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6694section.
6695
2d20f7bf
JJ
6696@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6697@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6698This is equivalent to either
6699@smallexample
6700(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6701@end smallexample
6702or
6703@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6704(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6705 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6706@end smallexample
6707@noindent
6708depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6709for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6710@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6711If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6712memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6713bytes in the on-disk file.
6714
6715This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6716any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6717@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6718be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6719running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6720that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6721page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6722
6723@noindent
6724Example:
6725@smallexample
6726 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6727@end smallexample
6728
6729@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6730@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6731This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6732evaluation purposes.
6733
6734@smallexample
6735 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6736@end smallexample
6737
a4f5ad88
JJ
6738@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6739@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6740This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6741@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6742When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6743does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6744@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6745argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6746script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6747@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6748padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6749section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6750
6751@smallexample
6752 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6753@end smallexample
6754
252b5132
RH
6755@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6756@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6757@cindex symbol defaults
6758Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6759defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6760return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6761default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6762shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6763the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6764existed, its value is preserved:
6765
6766@smallexample
6767@group
6768SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6769 .text : @{
6770 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6771 @dots{}
6772 @}
6773 @dots{}
6774@}
6775@end group
6776@end smallexample
6777
3ec57632
NC
6778@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6779@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6780Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6781
252b5132
RH
6782@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6783@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6784@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6785Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6786Section LMA}).
6787
2e53f7d6
NC
6788@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6789@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6790Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6791@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6792
252b5132
RH
6793@kindex MAX
6794@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6795Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6796
6797@kindex MIN
6798@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6799Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6800
6801@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6802@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6803@cindex unallocated address, next
6804Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6805This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6806use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6807output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6808
3ec57632
NC
6809@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6810@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6811Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6812
ba916c8a
MM
6813@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6814@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6815Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6816value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6817@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6818will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6819can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6820``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6821name.
6822
252b5132
RH
6823@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6824@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6825@cindex section size
6826Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6827been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6828evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6829@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6830@smallexample
6831@group
6832SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6833 .output @{
6834 .start = . ;
6835 @dots{}
6836 .end = . ;
6837 @}
6838 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6839 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6840@dots{} @}
6841@end group
6842@end smallexample
6843
6844@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6845@itemx sizeof_headers
6846@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6847@cindex header size
6848Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6849information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6850this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6851choose, to facilitate paging.
6852
6853@cindex not enough room for program headers
6854@cindex program headers, not enough room
6855When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6856@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6857number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6858addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6859additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6860room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6861the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6862script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6863you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6864command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6865@end table
6866
6867@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6868@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6869@cindex implicit linker scripts
6870If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6871an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6872linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
6873linker will report an error.
6874
6875An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
6876
6877Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
6878assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
6879commands.
6880
6881Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
6882at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
6883read. This can affect archive searching.
6884
6885@ifset GENERIC
6886@node Machine Dependent
6887@chapter Machine Dependent Features
6888
6889@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
6890@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
6891sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
6892functionality are not listed.
6893
6894@menu
36f63dca
NC
6895@ifset H8300
6896* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
6897@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
6898@ifset M68HC11
6899* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
6900@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
6901@ifset ARM
6902* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
6903@end ifset
6904@ifset HPPA
6905* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
6906@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
6907@ifset M68K
6908* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
6909@end ifset
833794fc
MR
6910@ifset MIPS
6911* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
6912@end ifset
3c3bdf30 6913@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 6914* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 6915@end ifset
2469cfa2 6916@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 6917* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 6918@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
6919@ifset NDS32
6920* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
6921@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
6922@ifset NIOSII
6923* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
6924@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
6925@ifset POWERPC
6926* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
6927@end ifset
6928@ifset POWERPC64
6929* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
6930@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
6931@ifset S/390
6932* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
6933@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
6934@ifset SPU
6935* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
6936@end ifset
74459f0e 6937@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 6938* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 6939@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
6940@ifset WIN32
6941* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
6942@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
6943@ifset XTENSA
6944* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
6945@end ifset
252b5132
RH
6946@end menu
6947@end ifset
6948
252b5132
RH
6949@ifset H8300
6950@ifclear GENERIC
6951@raisesections
6952@end ifclear
6953
6954@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 6955@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
6956
6957@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 6958For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
6959you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
6960
6961@table @emph
6962@cindex relaxing on H8/300
6963@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 6964@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
6965targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
6966program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
6967respectively.
6968
6969@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
6970@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 6971@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 6972@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
6973sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
6974page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
6975(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
6976@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
6977top page of memory).
1502569c 6978
81f5558e
NC
6979@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
6980indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
6981displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
6982the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
6983@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
6984whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
6985range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
6986
1502569c 6987@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 6988@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 6989biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 6990which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
6991page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
6992(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 6993@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
6994the top page of memory).
6995
6996@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
6997@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
699832 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
6999changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7000(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7001@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7002the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7003@end table
7004
7005@ifclear GENERIC
7006@lowersections
7007@end ifclear
7008@end ifset
7009
36f63dca 7010@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7011@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7012@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7013@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7014@node Renesas
7015@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7016
c2dcd04e
NC
7017@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7018H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7019options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7020@end ifset
7021@end ifclear
7022
36f63dca
NC
7023@ifset ARM
7024@ifclear GENERIC
7025@raisesections
7026@end ifclear
7027
93fd0973
SC
7028@ifset M68HC11
7029@ifclear GENERIC
7030@raisesections
7031@end ifclear
7032
7033@node M68HC11/68HC12
7034@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7035
7036@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7037
7038@subsection Linker Relaxation
7039
7040For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7041optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7042
7043@table @emph
7044@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7045@item relaxing address modes
7046@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7047targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7048program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7049respectively.
7050
7051@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7052transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7053page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7054
7055@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7056When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7057of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7058addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7059@code{bset} instructions.
7060
7061@end table
7062
7063@subsection Trampoline Generation
7064
7065@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7066@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7067For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7068call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7069will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7070trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7071case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7072point to the function trampoline.
7073
7074@ifclear GENERIC
7075@lowersections
7076@end ifclear
7077@end ifset
7078
36f63dca 7079@node ARM
3674e28a 7080@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7081
7082@cindex ARM interworking support
7083@kindex --support-old-code
7084For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7085between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7086been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7087line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7088libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7089option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7090given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7091which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7092the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7093non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7094
7095@cindex thumb entry point
7096@cindex entry point, thumb
7097@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7098The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7099@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7100But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7101branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7102executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7103
ce11ba6c
KT
7104@cindex PE import table prefixing
7105@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7106The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7107the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7108element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7109import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7110
e489d0ae
PB
7111@cindex BE8
7112@kindex --be8
7113The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7114executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7115objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7116option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7117little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7118
3674e28a
PB
7119@cindex TARGET1
7120@kindex --target1-rel
7121@kindex --target1-abs
7122The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7123@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7124or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7125and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7126
7127@cindex TARGET2
7128@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7129The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7130@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7131meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7132@table @samp
7133@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7134@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7135@item abs
7136@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7137@item got-rel
7138@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7139@end table
7140
319850b4
JB
7141@cindex FIX_V4BX
7142@kindex --fix-v4bx
7143The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7144specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7145interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7146also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7147
7148In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7149linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7150@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7151
7152In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7153relocations are ignored.
7154
845b51d6
PB
7155@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7156@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7157Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7158relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7159
7160@smallexample
7161TST rM, #1
7162MOVEQ PC, rM
7163BX Rn
7164@end smallexample
7165
7166This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7167and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7168condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7169
33bfe774
JB
7170@cindex USE_BLX
7171@kindex --use-blx
7172The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7173BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7174situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7175code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7176each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7177
7178This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7179specify it if you are using that target.
7180
c6dd86c6
JB
7181@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7182@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7183The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7184bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7185instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7186to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7187the support code can read the intended values.
7188
7189The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7190intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7191and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7192intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7193full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7194you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7195
7196If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7197enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7198@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7199mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7200vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7201@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7202
7203If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7204potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7205such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7206first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7207instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7208the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7209are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7210
2de70689
MGD
7211@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7212@kindex --fix-arm1176
7213@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7214The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7215in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7216are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7217unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7218
9d5777a3 7219Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7220Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7221http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7222
a504d23a
LA
7223@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7224@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7225
7226The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7227workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7228the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7229off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7230the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7231core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7232integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7233VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7234
7235The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7236necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7237
7238The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7239@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7240STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7241linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7242@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7243
7244If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7245potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7246such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7247replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7248branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7249then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7250
7251The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7252the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7253
7254The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7255they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7256there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7257occurs.
7258
7259The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7260PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7261large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7262cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7263occurs.
7264
bf21ed78
MS
7265@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7266@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7267The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7268warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7269enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7270linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7271using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7272not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7273
7274@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7275@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7276The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7277warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7278@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7279linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7280using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7281
726150b7
NC
7282@cindex PIC_VENEER
7283@kindex --pic-veneer
7284The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7285ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7286is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7287@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7288
7289@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7290@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7291The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7292code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7293perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7294placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7295controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7296The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7297duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7298group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7299code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7300where they should be placed.
7301
7302The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7303@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7304placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7305branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7306placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7307value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7308exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7309A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7310linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7311from the input sections.
7312
7313The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7314@samp{N = +1}.
7315
1a51c1a4
NC
7316Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7317only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7318otherwise.
7319
1db37fe6
YG
7320@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7321@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7322@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7323The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7324
7325The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7326
68fcca92
JW
7327@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7328@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7329@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7330The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7331
7332Please contact ARM for further details.
7333
1db37fe6
YG
7334@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7335@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7336@cindex Merging exidx entries
7337The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7338
7339@kindex --long-plt
7340@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7341The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7342which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7343entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7344
1f56df9d
JW
7345@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7346@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7347The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7348link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7349
4ba2ef8f
TP
7350@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7351All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7352Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7353@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7354veneers in memory.
7355
54ddd295
TP
7356@kindex --cmse-implib
7357@cindex Secure gateway import library
7358The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7359specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7360secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7361executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7362
0955507f
TP
7363@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7364@cindex Input import library
7365The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7366must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7367given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7368in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7369@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7370library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7371library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7372for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7373specified.
7374
36f63dca
NC
7375@ifclear GENERIC
7376@lowersections
7377@end ifclear
7378@end ifset
7379
7380@ifset HPPA
7381@ifclear GENERIC
7382@raisesections
7383@end ifclear
7384
7385@node HPPA ELF32
7386@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7387@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7388@kindex --multi-subspace
7389When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7390import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7391The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7392stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7393multiple sub-spaces.
7394
7395@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7396@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7397Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7398stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7399@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7400sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7401a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7402the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7403conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7404prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7405A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7406branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7407@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7408@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7409detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7410positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7411
7412Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7413single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7414create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7415large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7416
7417@ifclear GENERIC
7418@lowersections
7419@end ifclear
7420@end ifset
7421
7fb9f789
NC
7422@ifset M68K
7423@ifclear GENERIC
7424@raisesections
7425@end ifclear
7426
7427@node M68K
7428@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7429
7430@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7431@kindex --got=@var{type}
7432The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7433The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7434@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7435the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7436@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7437entries only at non-negative offsets.
7438@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7439entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7440support such GOTs.
7441@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7442output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7443file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7444files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7445
7446@ifclear GENERIC
7447@lowersections
7448@end ifclear
7449@end ifset
7450
833794fc
MR
7451@ifset MIPS
7452@ifclear GENERIC
7453@raisesections
7454@end ifclear
7455
7456@node MIPS
7457@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7458
7459@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7460@kindex --insn32
7461@kindex --no-insn32
7462The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7463microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7464in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7465used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7466or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7467including 16-bit ones where possible.
7468
8b10b0b3
MR
7469@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7470@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7471@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7472The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7473control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7474@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7475relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7476calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7477relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7478instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7479or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7480the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7481
833794fc
MR
7482@ifclear GENERIC
7483@lowersections
7484@end ifclear
7485@end ifset
7486
36f63dca
NC
7487@ifset MMIX
7488@ifclear GENERIC
7489@raisesections
7490@end ifclear
7491
7492@node MMIX
7493@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7494For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7495@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7496understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7497can translate between the two formats.
7498
7499There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7500Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7501registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7502equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7503@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7504global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7505this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7506symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7507
7a2de473
HPN
7508Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7509@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7510The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7511of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7512
7513Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7514are left out from an mmo file.
7515
7516@ifclear GENERIC
7517@lowersections
7518@end ifclear
7519@end ifset
7520
7521@ifset MSP430
7522@ifclear GENERIC
7523@raisesections
7524@end ifclear
7525
7526@node MSP430
7527@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7528For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7529will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7530just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7531
7532@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7533The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7534
7535@table @code
7536@item @samp{.vectors}
7537Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7538
7539@item @samp{.bootloader}
7540Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7541in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7542
7543@item @samp{.infomem}
7544Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7545this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7546
c0065db7 7547@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7548This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7549in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7550
7551@item @samp{.noinit}
7552Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7553
c0065db7 7554The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7555@end table
7556
7ef3addb
JL
7557@table @option
7558@cindex MSP430 Options
7559@kindex --code-region
7560@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7561This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7562argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7563using this option.
7564
7565@kindex --data-region
7566@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7567This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7568[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7569for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7570
7571@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7572@item --disable-sec-transformation
7573Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7574and @code{--data-region} options.
7575This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7576wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7577not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7578@end table
7579
36f63dca
NC
7580@ifclear GENERIC
7581@lowersections
7582@end ifclear
7583@end ifset
7584
35c08157
KLC
7585@ifset NDS32
7586@ifclear GENERIC
7587@raisesections
7588@end ifclear
7589
7590@node NDS32
7591@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7592@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7593For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7594relaxes objects according to these options.
7595
7596@table @code
7597@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7598Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7599
7600@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7601Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7602
7603@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7604Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7605
7606@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7607Export the EX9 table after linking.
7608
7609@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7610Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7611
7612@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7613Update the existing EX9 table.
7614
7615@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7616Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7617
7618@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7619Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7620
7621@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7622Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7623
7624@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7625Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7626@end table
7627
7628@ifclear GENERIC
7629@lowersections
7630@end ifclear
7631@end ifset
7632
78058a5e
SL
7633@ifset NIOSII
7634@ifclear GENERIC
7635@raisesections
7636@end ifclear
7637
7638@node Nios II
7639@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7640@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7641@kindex --relax on Nios II
7642
7643Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7644transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7645which may result in @command{ld} giving
7646@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7647The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7648trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7649outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7650trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7651be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7652larger than 256MB.
7653
7654The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7655is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7656@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7657locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7658source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7659register as a temporary.
7660
7661Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7662relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7663option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7664
7665@ifclear GENERIC
7666@lowersections
7667@end ifclear
7668@end ifset
7669
2a60a7a8
AM
7670@ifset POWERPC
7671@ifclear GENERIC
7672@raisesections
7673@end ifclear
7674
7675@node PowerPC ELF32
7676@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7677@cindex PowerPC long branches
7678@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7679Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7680displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7681@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7682@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7683the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7684section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7685section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7686@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7687both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7688considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7689
7690@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7691@table @option
7692@cindex PowerPC PLT
7693@kindex --bss-plt
7694@item --bss-plt
7695Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7696generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7697the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7698writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7699@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7700PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7701compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7702BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7703
016687f8
AM
7704@kindex --secure-plt
7705@item --secure-plt
7706@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7707@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7708when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7709layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7710style BSS PLT.
7711
2a60a7a8
AM
7712@cindex PowerPC GOT
7713@kindex --sdata-got
7714@item --sdata-got
7715The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7716sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7717@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7718section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7719@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7720@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7721@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7722@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7723PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7724pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7725GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7726really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7727
7728@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7729@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7730@item --emit-stub-syms
7731This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7732symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7733
7734@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7735@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7736@item --no-tls-optimize
7737PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7738sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7739disable the optimization.
7740@end table
7741
7742@ifclear GENERIC
7743@lowersections
7744@end ifclear
7745@end ifset
7746
7747@ifset POWERPC64
7748@ifclear GENERIC
7749@raisesections
7750@end ifclear
7751
7752@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7753@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7754
7755@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7756@table @option
7757@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7758@kindex --stub-group-size
7759@item --stub-group-size
7760Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7761by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7762@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7763sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7764a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7765the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7766conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7767prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7768A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7769branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7770@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7771@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7772detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7773positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7774
7775Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7776single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7777create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7778large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7779
7780@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7781@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7782@item --emit-stub-syms
7783This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7784symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7785
7786@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7787@kindex --dotsyms
7788@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7789@item --dotsyms
7790@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7791These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7792in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7793function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7794code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7795properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7796to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7797@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7798dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7799feature.
7800
7ae4ea7d
AM
7801@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7802@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7803@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7804@item --save-restore-funcs
7805@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7806These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7807provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7808@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7809function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7810link.
7811
2a60a7a8
AM
7812@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7813@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7814@item --no-tls-optimize
7815PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7816sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7817disable the optimization.
7818
7c9cf415
AM
7819@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7820@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
7821@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
7822@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
7823@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
7824@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
7825@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 7826These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
7827stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
7828an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
7829@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
7830stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
7831generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
7832__tls_get_addr_opt.
7833Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
7834much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
7835an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
7836will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
7837@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
7838and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
7839this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
7840Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 7841@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 7842register saves.
7c9cf415 7843
2a60a7a8
AM
7844@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
7845@kindex --no-opd-optimize
7846@item --no-opd-optimize
7847PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
7848corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 7849the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
7850Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
7851
7852@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
7853@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
7854@item --non-overlapping-opd
7855Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
7856@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
7857the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
7858entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
7859
7860@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
7861@kindex --no-toc-optimize
7862@item --no-toc-optimize
7863PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
7864entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
7865reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
7866marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
7867marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
7868relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
7869unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
7870reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
7871discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
7872reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
7873code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
7874optimization.
7875
d882c988
AM
7876@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
7877@kindex --no-inline-optimize
7878@item --no-inline-optimize
7879PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
7880marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
7881@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
7882a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
7883locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
7884disables that optimization.
7885
2a60a7a8
AM
7886@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
7887@kindex --no-multi-toc
7888@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
7889If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
7890@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
7891where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
7892entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
7893total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
7894grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
7895TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
7896calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
7897help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
789864K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
7899Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
7900
7901@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
7902@kindex --no-toc-sort
7903@item --no-toc-sort
7904By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
7905happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
7906placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
7907with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
7908referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
7909@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
7910results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
7911off this feature.
7912
7913@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
7914@kindex --plt-align
7915@kindex --no-plt-align
7916@item --plt-align
7917@itemx --no-plt-align
7918Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
7919aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
7920boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
7921specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
7922specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
7923if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
7924PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
7925
7926@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
7927@kindex --plt-static-chain
7928@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
7929@item --plt-static-chain
7930@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
7931Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
7932chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
7933chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
7934
7935@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
7936@kindex --plt-thread-safe
7937@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
7938@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 7939@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
7940With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
7941lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
7942another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
7943order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
7944memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
7945barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
7946looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
7947seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
7948default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
7949
7950@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
7951@kindex --plt-localentry
7952@kindex --no-plt-localentry
7953@item --plt-localentry
7954@itemx --no-localentry
7955ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
7956ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
7957(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
7958Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
7959or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
7960functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
7961in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
7962interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
7963including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
7964to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
7965complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
7966care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
7967
7968@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
7969@kindex --power10-stubs
7970@kindex --no-power10-stubs
7971@item --power10-stubs
7972@itemx --no-power10-stubs
7973When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
7974relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
7975linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
7976for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
7977power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
7978power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
7979allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
7980@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
7981auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
7982@end table
7983
7984@ifclear GENERIC
7985@lowersections
7986@end ifclear
7987@end ifset
7988
b4cbbe8f
AK
7989@ifset S/390
7990@ifclear GENERIC
7991@raisesections
7992@end ifclear
7993
7994@node S/390 ELF
7995@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7996
7997@cindex S/390 ELF options
7998@table @option
7999
8000@cindex S/390
8001@kindex --s390-pgste
8002@item --s390-pgste
8003This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8004segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8005binaries marked that way.
8006@end table
8007
8008@ifclear GENERIC
8009@lowersections
8010@end ifclear
8011@end ifset
8012
49fa1e15
AM
8013@ifset SPU
8014@ifclear GENERIC
8015@raisesections
8016@end ifclear
8017
8018@node SPU ELF
8019@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8020
8021@cindex SPU ELF options
8022@table @option
8023
8024@cindex SPU plugins
8025@kindex --plugin
8026@item --plugin
8027This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8028
8029@cindex SPU overlays
8030@kindex --no-overlays
8031@item --no-overlays
8032Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8033regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8034@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8035turns off all this special overlay handling.
8036
8037@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8038@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8039@item --emit-stub-syms
8040This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8041symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8042
8043@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8044@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8045@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8046This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8047function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8048on calls to non-overlay regions.
8049
8050@cindex SPU local store size
8051@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8052@item --local-store=lo:hi
8053@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8054the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8055range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8056
c0065db7 8057@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8058@kindex --stack-analysis
8059@item --stack-analysis
8060SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8061unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8062under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8063@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8064@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8065determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8066for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8067for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8068for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8069find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8070and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8071under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8072dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8073is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8074and calls will be given.
8075
c0065db7 8076@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8077@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8078@item --emit-stack-syms
8079This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8080in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8081These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8082functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8083functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8084such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8085The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8086@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8087@end table
8088
8089@ifclear GENERIC
8090@lowersections
8091@end ifclear
8092@end ifset
8093
36f63dca
NC
8094@ifset TICOFF
8095@ifclear GENERIC
8096@raisesections
8097@end ifclear
8098
8099@node TI COFF
8100@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8101@cindex TI COFF versions
8102@kindex --format=@var{version}
8103The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8104TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8105also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8106format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8107header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8108
8109@ifclear GENERIC
8110@lowersections
8111@end ifclear
8112@end ifset
8113
2ca22b03
NC
8114@ifset WIN32
8115@ifclear GENERIC
8116@raisesections
8117@end ifclear
8118
8119@node WIN32
8120@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8121
c0065db7 8122This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8123See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8124command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8125
8126@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8127@cindex import libraries
8128@item import libraries
69da35b5 8129The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8130libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8131regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8132archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8133support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8134@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8135
c0065db7
RM
8136@item exporting DLL symbols
8137@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8138The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8139
8140@table @emph
8141@item using auto-export functionality
8142@cindex using auto-export functionality
8143By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8144which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8145
0a5d968e
NC
8146@itemize
8147@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8148@item --exclude-symbols
8149@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8150@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8151@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8152@end itemize
8153
09e2aba4
DK
8154When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8155(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8156symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8157often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8158private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8159options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8160exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8161final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8162
8163If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8164command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8165if either of the following are true:
8166
8167@itemize
8168@item A DEF file is used.
8169@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8170@end itemize
dc8465bf 8171
c0065db7
RM
8172@item using a DEF file
8173@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8174Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8175an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8176exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8177name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8178command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8179
8180@example
8181gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8182@end example
8183
0a5d968e
NC
8184Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8185@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8186
dc8465bf
NC
8187Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8188
8189@example
4b5bd4e7 8190LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8191
8192EXPORTS
8193foo
8194bar
8195_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8196another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8197var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8198doo = foo == foo2
8199eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8200@end example
dc8465bf 8201
7fcab871 8202This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8203symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8204alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8205by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8206@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8207@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8208export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8209in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8210symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8211
6b31ad16
DS
8212The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8213name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8214the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8215
b45619c0
NC
8216When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8217library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8218@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8219executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8220
8221With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8222specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8223non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8224
8225If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8226or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8227filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8228
4b5bd4e7
DS
8229The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8230
8231@example
8232EXPORTS
8233 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8234 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8235 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8236@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8237
8238Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8239@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8240@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8241@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8242Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8243@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8244string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8245
8246The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8247
8248@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8249will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8250by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8251linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8252library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8253
8254@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8255The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8256the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8257@code{*_imp__foo}).
8258
8259@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8260well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8261read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8262variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8263the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8264extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8265application will behave unexpectedly.
8266
8267@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8268it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8269symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8270API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8271the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8272
4b5bd4e7
DS
8273See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8274other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8275
8276@cindex creating a DEF file
8277While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8278with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8279
8280@item Using decorations
8281@cindex Using decorations
8282Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8283itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8284declared as:
8285
8286@example
8287__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8288__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8289@end example
8290
8291All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8292any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8293this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8294the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8295
8296Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8297decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8298instead:
8299
8300@example
8301__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8302__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8303@end example
8304
c0065db7
RM
8305This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8306when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8307variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8308code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8309of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8310omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8311@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8312information.
c0065db7 8313@end table
dc8465bf 8314
2ca22b03
NC
8315@cindex automatic data imports
8316@item automatic data imports
8317The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8318by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8319compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8320issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8321code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8322c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8323initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8324decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8325platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8326command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8327The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8328suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8329trigger the feature's use.
8330
c0065db7 8331auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8332additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8333
c0065db7 8334"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8335documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8336
c0065db7
RM
8337The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8338occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8339One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8340below.
8341
8342@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8343For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8344object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8345offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8346field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8347in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8348without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8349The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8350references.
8351
c0065db7
RM
8352The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8353be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8354themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8355runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8356compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8357support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8358run without error on an older system.
8359
c0065db7
RM
8360@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8361enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8362
8363@cindex direct linking to a dll
8364@item direct linking to a dll
8365The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8366including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8367libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8368traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8369libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8370function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8371though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8372storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8373tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8374large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8375
c0065db7 8376Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8377@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8378of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8379perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8380select the dll instead of an import library.
8381
2ca22b03 8382
69da35b5
NC
8383For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8384to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8385
8386@example
45e948fe
NC
8387libxxx.dll.a
8388xxx.dll.a
8389libxxx.a
8390xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8391libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8392cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8393libxxx.dll
8394xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8395@end example
8396
69da35b5
NC
8397before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8398
c0065db7
RM
8399(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8400where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8401@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8402file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8403@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8404
c0065db7
RM
8405Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8406@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8407was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8408various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8409could coexist on the same machine.
8410
2ca22b03
NC
8411The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8412applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8413libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8414
8415@example
8416bin/
8417 cygxxx.dll
8418lib/
8419 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8420 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8421@end example
8422
c0065db7
RM
8423Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8424done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8425
84261. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8427@example
8428gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8429@end example
2ca22b03 8430
69da35b5
NC
8431However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8432(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8433@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8434not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8435
2ca22b03
NC
84362. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8437directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8438should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8439making the app/dll.
8440
8441@example
8442ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8443@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8444
8445Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8446
8447@example
8448gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8449@end example
69da35b5
NC
8450
8451This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8452perfectly legal
8453
8454@example
8455bin/
8456 cygxxx-5.dll
8457lib/
c0065db7 8458 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8459@end example
8460
dc8465bf 8461Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8462even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8463@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8464
8465Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8466wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8467
84681. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8469work with auto-imported data.
8470
dc8465bf
NC
84712. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8472import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8473symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8474for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8475possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8476
45e948fe
NC
84773. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8478critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8479in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8480stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8481
69da35b5 8482So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8483true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8484a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8485binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8486massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8487requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8488will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8489
c0065db7 8490@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8491@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8492@item adding additional names
8493Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8494A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8495exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8496when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8497import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8498
c0065db7 8499@example
dc8465bf
NC
8500LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8501
8502EXPORTS
c0065db7 8503foo
dc8465bf 8504_foo = foo
c0065db7 8505@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8506
8507The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8508
8509Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8510source code using the "weak" attribute:
8511
c0065db7
RM
8512@example
8513void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8514void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8515@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8516
8517See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8518symbols.
8519
8520@item renaming symbols
8521Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8522kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8523@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8524DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8525created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8526
c0065db7 8527@example
dc8465bf
NC
8528LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8529
8530EXPORTS
8531_foo = foo
c0065db7 8532@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8533
8534The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8535@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8536@end table
dc8465bf 8537
0a5d968e 8538Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8539unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8540If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8541@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8542that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8543@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8544renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8545to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8546the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8547In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8548which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8549
8550@cindex weak externals
8551@item weak externals
8552The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8553weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8554defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8555are three variants of weak externals:
8556@itemize
8557@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8558called lazy externals.
8559@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8560This form is not presently implemented.
8561@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8562implemented.
8563@end itemize
8564As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8565are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8566uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8567
8568@cindex aligned common symbols
8569@item aligned common symbols
8570As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8571desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8572the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8573carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8574by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8575tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8576but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8577warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8578
2ca22b03
NC
8579@end table
8580
8581@ifclear GENERIC
8582@lowersections
8583@end ifclear
8584@end ifset
8585
e0001a05
NC
8586@ifset XTENSA
8587@ifclear GENERIC
8588@raisesections
8589@end ifclear
8590
8591@node Xtensa
8592@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8593
8594@cindex Xtensa processors
8595The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8596@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8597specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8598keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8599example, with the command:
8600
8601@smallexample
8602SECTIONS
8603@{
8604 .text : @{
8605 *(.literal .text)
8606 @}
8607@}
8608@end smallexample
8609
8610@noindent
8611@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8612and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8613literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8614interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8615group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8616files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8617and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8618
43cd72b9 8619@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8620@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8621Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8622provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8623is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8624literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8625will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8626location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8627the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8628unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8629@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8630range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8631
8632For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8633to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8634instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8635instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8636instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8637@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8638hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8639By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8640switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8641density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8642instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8643performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8644linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8645a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8646
8647The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8648control the linker:
8649
8650@cindex Xtensa options
8651@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8652@item --size-opt
8653When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8654more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8655no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8656alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8657preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8658
8659@item --abi-windowed
8660@itemx --abi-call0
8661Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8662PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8663because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8664conventions.
8665Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8666of the first input object.
8667A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8668or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8669@end table
e0001a05
NC
8670
8671@ifclear GENERIC
8672@lowersections
8673@end ifclear
8674@end ifset
8675
252b5132
RH
8676@ifclear SingleFormat
8677@node BFD
8678@chapter BFD
8679
8680@cindex back end
8681@cindex object file management
8682@cindex object formats available
8683@kindex objdump -i
8684The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8685These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8686object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8687format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8688it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8689associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8690object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8691(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8692list all the formats available for your configuration.
8693
8694@cindex BFD requirements
8695@cindex requirements for BFD
8696As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8697several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8698BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8699formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8700been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8701BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8702may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8703
8704One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8705mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8706useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8707conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8708
8709@menu
8710* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8711@end menu
8712
8713@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8714@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8715@cindex opening object files
8716@include bfdsumm.texi
8717@end ifclear
8718
8719@node Reporting Bugs
8720@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8721@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8722@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8723
ff5dcc92 8724Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8725
8726Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8727it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8728to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8729work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8730@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8731
8732In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8733information that enables us to fix the bug.
8734
8735@menu
8736* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8737* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8738@end menu
8739
8740@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8741@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8742@cindex bug criteria
8743
8744If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8745
8746@itemize @bullet
8747@cindex fatal signal
8748@cindex linker crash
8749@cindex crash of linker
8750@item
8751If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8752@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8753
8754@cindex error on valid input
8755@item
ff5dcc92 8756If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8757
8758@cindex invalid input
8759@item
ff5dcc92 8760If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8761may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8762object files are correct.
8763
8764@item
8765If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8766improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8767@end itemize
8768
8769@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8770@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8771@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8772@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8773
8774A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8775products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8776recommend you contact that organization first.
8777
8778You can find contact information for many support companies and
8779individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8780distribution.
8781
ad22bfe8 8782@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8783Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8784@value{BUGURL}.
8785@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8786
8787The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8788@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8789fact or leave it out, state it!
8790
8791Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8792problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8793assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8794matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8795the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8796location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8797were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8798into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8799specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8800and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8801
8802Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8803the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8804on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8805
8806Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8807bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8808respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8809You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8810
8811To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8812
8813@itemize @bullet
8814@item
ff5dcc92 8815The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8816the @samp{--version} argument.
8817
8818Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8819the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8820
8821@item
ff5dcc92 8822Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
8823patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
8824
8825@item
8826The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
8827version number.
8828
8829@item
ff5dcc92 8830What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
8831``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
8832
8833@item
8834The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
8835observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
8836list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
8837sufficient.
8838
8839If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
8840and then we might not encounter the bug.
8841
8842@item
8843A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
8844bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
8845provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
8846bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
8847state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
8848requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
8849we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
8850attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
8851
8852If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
8853@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
8854object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
8855@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
8856how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
8857
8858@item
8859A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
8860incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
8861
ff5dcc92 8862Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
8863will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
8864not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
8865a chance to make a mistake.
8866
8867Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
8868say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 8869copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
8870C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
8871and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
8872fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
8873you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
8874any conclusion from our observations.
8875
8876@item
ff5dcc92 8877If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
8878diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
8879@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 8880If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
8881context, not by line number.
8882
8883The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
8884sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
8885@end itemize
8886
8887Here are some things that are not necessary:
8888
8889@itemize @bullet
8890@item
8891A description of the envelope of the bug.
8892
8893Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
8894which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
8895changes will not affect it.
8896
8897This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
8898will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
8899with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
8900We recommend that you save your time for something else.
8901
8902Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
8903of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
8904output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
8905less time, and so on.
8906
8907However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
8908report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
8909
8910@item
8911A patch for the bug.
8912
8913A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
8914the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
8915a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
8916to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
8917
ff5dcc92 8918Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
8919construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
8920through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
8921able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
8922fixed.
8923
8924And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
8925patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
8926help us to understand.
8927
8928@item
8929A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
8930
8931Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
8932things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
8933@end itemize
8934
8935@node MRI
8936@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
8937@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
8938To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
8939linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
8940alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
8941described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
8942simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 8943@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
8944linker commands; these commands are described here.
8945
8946In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
8947file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
8948features to make use of them.
8949
8950You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
8951@samp{-c} command-line option.
8952
8953Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
8954command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
8955blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 8956MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
8957issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
8958
8959Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
8960
8961You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
8962lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
8963The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
8964
8965@table @code
8966@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
8967@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
8968@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 8969Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
8970the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
8971@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
8972your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
8973script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
8974commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
8975input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
8976@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
8977
8978@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
8979@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
8980Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
8981in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
8982
8983@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
8984
8985@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
8986@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
8987Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
8988@var{expression} should be a power of two.
8989
8990@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
8991@item BASE @var{expression}
8992Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
8993absolute addresses) in the output file.
8994
8995@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
8996@item CHIP @var{expression}
8997@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
8998This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
8999
9000@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9001@item END
9002This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9003
9004@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9005@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9006Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9007language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9008
9009@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9010@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9011Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9012@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9013
9014The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9015same line, with no change in its effect.
9016
9017@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9018@item LOAD @var{filename}
9019@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9020Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9021same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9022command line.
9023
9024@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9025@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9026@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9027MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9028option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9029
9030@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9031@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9032@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9033Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9034order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9035script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9036sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9037file, in the order specified.
9038
9039@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9040@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9041@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9042@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9043Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9044@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9045
9046@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9047@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9048@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9049@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9050You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9051specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9052If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9053@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9054@end table
9055
793c5807
NC
9056@node GNU Free Documentation License
9057@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9058@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9059
370b66a1
CD
9060@node LD Index
9061@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9062
9063@printindex cp
9064
9065@tex
7ca01ed9 9066% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9067% meantime:
9068\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9069\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9070\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9071\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9072\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9073\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9074\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9075\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9076\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9077% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9078@end tex
9079
252b5132 9080@bye